blob: a6ac07f25cbde3101aa7fedac55d3e067fdc558a [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Chandler Carruthaa36b892015-12-30 03:40:23 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclContextInternals.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000024#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000025#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000027#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000028#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000029#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000031#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000032#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000033#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000034#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000035#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000036#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000039#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000040#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000041#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000042#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000043
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000044using namespace clang;
45
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000046unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000048unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000050unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000052unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000054unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000056unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000059enum FloatingRank {
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +000060 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank, Float128Rank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000061};
62
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000063RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000064 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +000066
67#ifndef NDEBUG
68 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71#endif
72
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000073 CommentsLoaded = true;
74 }
75
76 assert(D);
77
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000078 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000080 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000081
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000082 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000085 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000086 }
87
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000088 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000091 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000092 }
93
94 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000096 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000097 }
98
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000099 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000104 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000105 }
106
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000107 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000109 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000110 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000111 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000115 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000116 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000117 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000119 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000120
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000121 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122 // documentation.
123 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000126 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000127
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000128 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000129
130 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000132 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000133
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000134 // Find declaration location.
135 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137 // location".
138 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000142 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000143 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000146 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000147 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000148 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152 // the "declaration location".
153 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
158 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163 }
164 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000165 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000166
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000169 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000170 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000171
172 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000173 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174 {
175 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000178 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000181 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187 }
188
189 if (Found) {
190 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193 } else {
194 // Slow path.
195 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197 }
198 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000199
200 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201 // file buffer.
202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203
204 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000206 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000207 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000208 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000209 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000210 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000211 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000217 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000218 }
219 }
220
221 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222 // Let's look at the previous comment.
223 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000224 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000225 --Comment;
226
227 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000228 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000229 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000230
231 // Decompose the end of the comment.
232 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000233 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000234
235 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236 // aren't related.
237 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000238 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000239
240 // Get the corresponding buffer.
241 bool Invalid = false;
242 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243 &Invalid).data();
244 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000245 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000246
247 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000251 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000253 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000254 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000255
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000257}
258
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000259namespace {
260/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000262/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000263const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000264 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000265 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000266 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000267 return FTD;
268
269 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271 return D;
272
273 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275 return FTD;
276
277 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280 return MemberDecl;
281
282 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000283 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000284 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286 // template?
287 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289 return MemberDecl;
290
291 return D;
292 }
293 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296 return CTD;
297
298 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299 // specialization?
300 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303 return D;
304 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(
310 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311 }
312
313 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317
318 return D;
319 }
320 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323 return MemberDecl;
324
325 return D;
326 }
327 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000328 return D;
329}
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +0000330} // anonymous namespace
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000331
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000332const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333 const Decl *D,
334 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000335 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000336
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000337 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338 {
339 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340 RedeclComments.find(D);
341 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000343 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344 if (OriginalDecl)
345 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000346 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000347 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000348 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000349 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000350
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000351 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000352 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000354 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000355 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000356 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000357 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000361 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000362 break;
363 }
364 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000365 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368 if (RC) {
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000369 // Call order swapped to work around ICE in VS2015 RTM (Release Win32)
370 // https://connect.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/feedback/details/1741530
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000371 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000372 Raw.setRaw(RC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000373 } else
374 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000375 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
376 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000377 if (RC)
378 break;
379 }
380 }
381
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000382 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
383 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000384
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000385 if (OriginalDecl)
386 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
387
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000388 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
389 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
390 Raw.setRaw(RC);
391 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000392 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000393
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000394 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
395 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000396 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
397 R = Raw;
398 }
399
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000400 return RC;
401}
402
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000403static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
404 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
405 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
406 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
407 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
408 if (!ID)
409 return;
410 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000411 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000412 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000413 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000414 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
415 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
416 }
417 }
418}
419
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000420comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
421 const Decl *D) const {
422 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
423 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
424 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
425 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
426 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000427 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
428 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000429 comments::FullComment *CFC =
430 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
431 ThisDeclInfo);
432 return CFC;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000433}
434
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000435comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
436 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000437 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000438}
439
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000440comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
441 const Decl *D,
442 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000443 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000444 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000445 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000446
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000447 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
448 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
449 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000450
451 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000452 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000453 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000454 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000455 return CFC;
456 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000457 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000458 }
459
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000460 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000461
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000462 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000463 if (!RC) {
464 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000465 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000466 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000467 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
468 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
469 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
470 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000471 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000472 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
473 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000474 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
475 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
476 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000477 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000478 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000479 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000480 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000481 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000482 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
483 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
484 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000485 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000486 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000487 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
488 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
489 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
490 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
491 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
492 }
493 }
494 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
495 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
496 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
497 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
498 }
499 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
500 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000501 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000502 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000503 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
504 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000505 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000506 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000507 if (Ty.isNull())
508 continue;
509 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
510 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
511 continue;
512
513 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
514 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
515 }
516 }
517 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000518 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
519 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000520 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000521 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000522 if (Ty.isNull())
523 continue;
524 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
525 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
526 continue;
527 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
528 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
529 }
530 }
531 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000532 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000533 }
534
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000535 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
536 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
537 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
538 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000539 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000540 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000541
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000542 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000543 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
544 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000545}
546
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000547void
548ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
549 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
550 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
551 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000552 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000553
554 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
555 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
556 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
557 PEnd = Params->end();
558 P != PEnd; ++P) {
559 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
560 ID.AddInteger(0);
561 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
562 continue;
563 }
564
565 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
566 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000567 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000568 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000569 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
570 ID.AddBoolean(true);
571 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000572 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
573 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
574 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
575 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000576 } else
577 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000578 continue;
579 }
580
581 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
582 ID.AddInteger(2);
583 Profile(ID, TTP);
584 }
585}
586
587TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
588ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000589 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000590 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
591 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
592 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000593 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000594 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
595 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
596 if (Canonical)
597 return Canonical->getParam();
598
599 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
600 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000601 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000602 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
603 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
604 PEnd = Params->end();
605 P != PEnd; ++P) {
606 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
607 CanonParams.push_back(
608 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000609 SourceLocation(),
610 SourceLocation(),
611 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000612 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000613 TTP->isParameterPack()));
614 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000615 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
616 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
617 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
618 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
619 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000620 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
621 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000622 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
623 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
624 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
625 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
626 }
627
628 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000629 SourceLocation(),
630 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000631 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000632 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000633 T,
634 TInfo,
David Majnemerdfecf1a2016-07-06 04:19:16 +0000635 ExpandedTypes,
636 ExpandedTInfos);
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000637 } else {
638 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000639 SourceLocation(),
640 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000641 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000642 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000643 T,
644 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645 TInfo);
646 }
647 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648
649 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652 }
653
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000654 assert(!TTP->getRequiresClause() &&
655 "Unexpected requires-clause on template template-parameter");
George Burgess IVb7e4e482016-08-25 01:54:37 +0000656 Expr *const CanonRequiresClause = nullptr;
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000657
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000658 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
659 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
660 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000661 TTP->getPosition(),
662 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000663 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000664 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
665 SourceLocation(),
David Majnemer902f8c62015-12-27 07:16:27 +0000666 CanonParams,
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000667 SourceLocation(),
668 CanonRequiresClause));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000669
670 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
671 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000672 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000673 (void)Canonical;
674
675 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
676 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
677 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
678 return CanonTTP;
679}
680
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000681CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000682 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000683
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000684 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000685 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000686 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000687 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +0000688 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000689 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +0000690 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000691 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +0000692 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000693 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000694 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000695 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
696 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000697 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000698}
699
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000700static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000701 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
702 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
703 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
704 // language-specific address space.
705 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
706 1, // opencl_global
707 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000708 3, // opencl_constant
Anastasia Stulova2c8dcfb2014-11-26 14:10:06 +0000709 4, // opencl_generic
710 5, // cuda_device
711 6, // cuda_constant
712 7 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000713 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000714 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000715 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000716 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000717 }
718}
719
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000720static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
721 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
722 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000723 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
724 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
725 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
726 return true;
727 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
728 return false;
729 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000730 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000731}
732
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000733ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000734 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000735 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000736 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
737 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
738 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
739 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr), Int128Decl(nullptr),
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +0000740 UInt128Decl(nullptr), BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr),
741 BuiltinMSVaListDecl(nullptr), ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr),
742 ObjCClassDecl(nullptr), ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +0000743 CFConstantStringTagDecl(nullptr), CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr),
744 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr), FILEDecl(nullptr), jmp_bufDecl(nullptr),
745 sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr), ucontext_tDecl(nullptr),
746 BlockDescriptorType(nullptr), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr),
747 cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr), FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Eric Fiselier6ad68552016-07-01 01:24:09 +0000748 ExternCContext(nullptr), MakeIntegerSeqDecl(nullptr),
749 TypePackElementDecl(nullptr), SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Alexey Samsonova511cdd2015-02-04 17:40:08 +0000750 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000751 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), AuxTarget(nullptr),
752 PrintingPolicy(LOpts), Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
753 BuiltinInfo(builtins), DeclarationNames(*this), ExternalSource(nullptr),
754 Listener(nullptr), Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000755 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000756 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
757}
758
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000759ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000760 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
761
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000762 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
763 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
764 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000765
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000766 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000767 for (auto &Pair : Deallocations)
768 (Pair.first)(Pair.second);
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000769
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000770 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000771 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
772 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
773 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
774 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
775 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
776 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
777 R->Destroy(*this);
778
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000779 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
780 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
781 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
782 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
783 R->Destroy(*this);
784 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000785
786 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
787 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
788 A != AEnd; ++A)
789 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000790
David Majnemere694f3e2015-08-14 14:43:50 +0000791 for (std::pair<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue *> &MTVPair :
792 MaterializedTemporaryValues)
793 MTVPair.second->~APValue();
794
Richard Smith423f46f2016-07-20 21:38:26 +0000795 for (const auto &Value : ModuleInitializers)
796 Value.second->~PerModuleInitializers();
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000797}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000798
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000799void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +0000800 if (!PointerParents) return;
801 for (const auto &Entry : *PointerParents) {
802 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
803 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
804 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
805 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
806 }
807 }
808 for (const auto &Entry : *OtherParents) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000809 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
810 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +0000811 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000812 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
813 }
814 }
815}
816
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000817void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000818 Deallocations.push_back({Callback, Data});
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000819}
820
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000821void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000822ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
Benjamin Kramerd6da1a02016-06-12 20:05:23 +0000823 ExternalSource = std::move(Source);
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000824}
825
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000826void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000827 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
828 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000829
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000830 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000831#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000832#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
833#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
834 0 // Extra
835 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000836
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000837 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
838 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000839 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000840 }
841
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000842 unsigned Idx = 0;
843 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
844#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
845 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000846 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
847 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000848 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
849 ++Idx;
850#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
851#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000852
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000853 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
854
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000855 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000856 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
857 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
858 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
859 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
860 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
861 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000862 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000863 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
864 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
865 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
866 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
867 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
868 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000869 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000870 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
871 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
872 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
873 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
874 << NumImplicitDestructors
875 << " implicit destructors created\n";
876
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000877 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000878 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000879 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
880 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000881
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000882 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000883}
884
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000885void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
886 bool NotifyListeners) {
887 if (NotifyListeners)
888 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
889 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
890
Benjamin Kramera72a70a2016-10-17 13:00:44 +0000891 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
892 MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M);
893 else
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000894 ND->setHidden(false);
895}
896
897void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
898 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND);
899 if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
900 return;
901
Benjamin Kramera72a70a2016-10-17 13:00:44 +0000902 auto &Merged = It->second;
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000903 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
904 for (Module *&M : Merged)
905 if (!Found.insert(M).second)
906 M = nullptr;
907 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
908}
909
Richard Smithdc1f0422016-07-20 19:10:16 +0000910void ASTContext::PerModuleInitializers::resolve(ASTContext &Ctx) {
911 if (LazyInitializers.empty())
912 return;
913
914 auto *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
915 assert(Source && "lazy initializers but no external source");
916
917 auto LazyInits = std::move(LazyInitializers);
918 LazyInitializers.clear();
919
920 for (auto ID : LazyInits)
921 Initializers.push_back(Source->GetExternalDecl(ID));
922
923 assert(LazyInitializers.empty() &&
924 "GetExternalDecl for lazy module initializer added more inits");
925}
926
927void ASTContext::addModuleInitializer(Module *M, Decl *D) {
928 // One special case: if we add a module initializer that imports another
929 // module, and that module's only initializer is an ImportDecl, simplify.
930 if (auto *ID = dyn_cast<ImportDecl>(D)) {
931 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(ID->getImportedModule());
932
933 // Maybe the ImportDecl does nothing at all. (Common case.)
934 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
935 return;
936
937 // Maybe the ImportDecl only imports another ImportDecl.
938 auto &Imported = *It->second;
939 if (Imported.Initializers.size() + Imported.LazyInitializers.size() == 1) {
940 Imported.resolve(*this);
941 auto *OnlyDecl = Imported.Initializers.front();
942 if (isa<ImportDecl>(OnlyDecl))
943 D = OnlyDecl;
944 }
945 }
946
947 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
948 if (!Inits)
949 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
950 Inits->Initializers.push_back(D);
951}
952
953void ASTContext::addLazyModuleInitializers(Module *M, ArrayRef<uint32_t> IDs) {
954 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
955 if (!Inits)
956 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
957 Inits->LazyInitializers.insert(Inits->LazyInitializers.end(),
958 IDs.begin(), IDs.end());
959}
960
961ArrayRef<Decl*> ASTContext::getModuleInitializers(Module *M) {
962 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(M);
963 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
964 return None;
965
966 auto *Inits = It->second;
967 Inits->resolve(*this);
968 return Inits->Initializers;
969}
970
Richard Smithf19e1272015-03-07 00:04:49 +0000971ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
972 if (!ExternCContext)
973 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
974
975 return ExternCContext;
976}
977
David Majnemerd9b1a4f2015-11-04 03:40:30 +0000978BuiltinTemplateDecl *
979ASTContext::buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK,
980 const IdentifierInfo *II) const {
981 auto *BuiltinTemplate = BuiltinTemplateDecl::Create(*this, TUDecl, II, BTK);
982 BuiltinTemplate->setImplicit();
983 TUDecl->addDecl(BuiltinTemplate);
984
985 return BuiltinTemplate;
986}
987
988BuiltinTemplateDecl *
989ASTContext::getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const {
990 if (!MakeIntegerSeqDecl)
991 MakeIntegerSeqDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__make_integer_seq,
992 getMakeIntegerSeqName());
993 return MakeIntegerSeqDecl;
994}
995
Eric Fiselier6ad68552016-07-01 01:24:09 +0000996BuiltinTemplateDecl *
997ASTContext::getTypePackElementDecl() const {
998 if (!TypePackElementDecl)
999 TypePackElementDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__type_pack_element,
1000 getTypePackElementName());
1001 return TypePackElementDecl;
1002}
1003
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001004RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
1005 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001006 SourceLocation Loc;
1007 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001008 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
1009 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
1010 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001011 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001012 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
1013 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001014 NewDecl->setImplicit();
David Majnemerf8637362015-01-15 08:41:25 +00001015 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
1016 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001017 return NewDecl;
1018}
1019
1020TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
1021 StringRef Name) const {
1022 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
1023 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
1024 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
1025 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
1026 NewDecl->setImplicit();
1027 return NewDecl;
1028}
1029
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001030TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001031 if (!Int128Decl)
1032 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001033 return Int128Decl;
1034}
1035
1036TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001037 if (!UInt128Decl)
1038 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001039 return UInt128Decl;
1040}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +00001041
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00001042void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00001043 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00001044 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00001045 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00001046}
1047
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +00001048void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target,
1049 const TargetInfo *AuxTarget) {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001050 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
1051 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001052 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001053
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001054 this->Target = &Target;
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +00001055 this->AuxTarget = AuxTarget;
1056
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001057 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
1058 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +00001059 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001060
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001061 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001062 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001063
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001064 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001065 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001066 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +00001067 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +00001068 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
1069 else
1070 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001071 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001072 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
1073 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
1074 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
1075 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
1076 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001077
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001078 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001079 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
1080 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
1081 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
1082 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
1083 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001084
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001085 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001086 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
1087 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
1088 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001089
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001090 // GNU extension, __float128 for IEEE quadruple precision
1091 InitBuiltinType(Float128Ty, BuiltinType::Float128);
1092
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00001093 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
1094 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
1095 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
1096
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +00001097 // C++ 3.9.1p5
1098 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
1099 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1100 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1101 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1102 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1103 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1104 else {
1105 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1106 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1107 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001108
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +00001109 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1110
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001111 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1112 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
1113 else // C99
1114 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1115
1116 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1117 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
1118 else // C99
1119 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1120
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001121 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1122 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1123 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1124 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1125 // expressions.
1126 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001127
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00001128 // Placeholder type for functions.
1129 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1130
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001131 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1132 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1133
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001134 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1135 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1136
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001137 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1138 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1139
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001140 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1141 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1142
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001143 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1144 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1145
Alexey Bataev1a3320e2015-08-25 14:24:04 +00001146 // Placeholder type for OMP array sections.
1147 if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
1148 InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection);
1149
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001150 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001151 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1152 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1153 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001154 Float128ComplexTy = getComplexType(Float128Ty);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001155
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001156 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001157 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1158 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001159 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001160
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00001161 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1162#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1163 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00001164#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001165
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001166 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001167 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001168 InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
1169 InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
1170 InitBuiltinType(OCLNDRangeTy, BuiltinType::OCLNDRange);
1171 InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001172 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001173
1174 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001175 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1176 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001177
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001178 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001179
1180 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001181
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001182 // void * type
1183 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001184
1185 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1186 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001187
1188 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1189 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001190
1191 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00001192 VaListTagDecl = nullptr;
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001193}
1194
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001195DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001196 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1197}
1198
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001199AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1200 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1201 if (!Result) {
1202 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1203 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1204 }
1205
1206 return *Result;
1207}
1208
1209/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1210void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1211 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1212 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1213 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1214 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1215 }
1216}
1217
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001218// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001219MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001220ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001221 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001222 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1223 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1224}
1225
1226ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1227ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1228 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1229 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1230 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1231 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001232
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001233 return Pos->second;
1234}
1235
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001236void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001237ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001238 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1239 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001240 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1241 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001242 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1243 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1244}
1245
1246void
1247ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1248 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1249 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1250 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1251 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001252}
1253
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001254FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1255 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1256 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1257 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001258 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1259 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001260 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001261
1262 return Pos->second;
1263}
1264
1265void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1266 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1267 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1268 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001269 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001270}
1271
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001272NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001273ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001274 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001275 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1276 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001277 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001278
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001279 return Pos->second;
1280}
1281
1282void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001283ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1284 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1285 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1286 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1287 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1288 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1289 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1290}
1291
1292UsingShadowDecl *
1293ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1294 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1295 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1296 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001297 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001298
1299 return Pos->second;
1300}
1301
1302void
1303ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1304 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1305 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1306 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001307}
1308
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001309FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1310 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1311 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1312 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001313 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001314
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001315 return Pos->second;
1316}
1317
1318void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1319 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1320 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1321 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1322 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1323 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001324
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001325 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1326}
1327
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001328ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1329ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001330 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1331 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001332 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001333 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001334 return Pos->second.begin();
1335}
1336
1337ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1338ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001339 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1340 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001341 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001342 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001343 return Pos->second.end();
1344}
1345
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001346unsigned
1347ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001348 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1349 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001350 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1351 return 0;
Chandler Carruthb1bcd5d2016-06-11 04:45:38 +00001352 return Pos->second.size();
Clement Courbet8251ebf2016-06-10 11:54:43 +00001353}
1354
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001355ASTContext::overridden_method_range
1356ASTContext::overridden_methods(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1357 return overridden_method_range(overridden_methods_begin(Method),
1358 overridden_methods_end(Method));
1359}
1360
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001361void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1362 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001363 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001364 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1365}
1366
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001367void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1368 const NamedDecl *D,
1369 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001370 assert(D);
1371
1372 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001373 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1374 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001375 return;
1376 }
1377
1378 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1379 if (!Method)
1380 return;
1381
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001382 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1383 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001384 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001385}
1386
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001387void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1388 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1389 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1390 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1391 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1392 LastLocalImport = Import;
1393 return;
1394 }
1395
1396 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1397 LastLocalImport = Import;
1398}
1399
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001400//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1401// Type Sizing and Analysis
1402//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001403
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001404/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1405/// scalar floating point type.
1406const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001407 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001408 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1409 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001410 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001411 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001412 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1413 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1414 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001415 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Target->getFloat128Format();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001416 }
1417}
1418
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001419CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001420 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001421
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001422 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1423 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1424 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001425
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001426 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1427 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1428 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1429 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001430 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001431 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1432 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1433 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1434 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1435 } else {
1436 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1437 }
1438 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001439 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1440 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1441 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1442 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001443
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001444 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1445 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001446 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001447 // do nothing
1448
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001449 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001450 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001451 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001452 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001453 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1454 else
1455 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1456 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001457 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1458 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001459 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1460 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001461 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001462 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1463 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001464 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1465 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1466 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1467 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1468 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1469 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001470 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001471 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001472 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Ulrich Weigandb63f7792015-04-21 17:26:18 +00001473 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001474 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1475 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001476 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001477
1478 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1479 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1480 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1481 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1482 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001483 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1484 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1485 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1486 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1487 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001488
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001489 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1490 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001491
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001492 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1493 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1494 if (Offset > 0) {
1495 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1496 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1497 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1498 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1499 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1500 }
1501
1502 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001503 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001504 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001505 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001506
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001507 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001508}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001509
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001510// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1511// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1512// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1513// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1514std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1515ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1516 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1517
1518 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1519 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1520 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1521 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1522 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1523 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1524 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1525 }
1526 }
1527
1528 return sizeAndAlign;
1529}
1530
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001531/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1532/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1533std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1534static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1535 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1536 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1537 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1538 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001539 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1540 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001541 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1542 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1543 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001544 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1545 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001546 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001547 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1548 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1549}
1550
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001551std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001552ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001553 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1554 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001555 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1556 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1557 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001558}
1559
1560std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001561ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001562 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1563}
1564
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001565bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1566 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1567}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001568
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001569bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1570 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1571}
1572
Richard Smithb2f0f052016-10-10 18:54:32 +00001573unsigned ASTContext::getTypeAlignIfKnown(QualType T) const {
1574 // An alignment on a typedef overrides anything else.
1575 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1576 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1577 return Align;
1578
1579 // If we have an (array of) complete type, we're done.
1580 T = getBaseElementType(T);
1581 if (!T->isIncompleteType())
1582 return getTypeAlign(T);
1583
1584 // If we had an array type, its element type might be a typedef
1585 // type with an alignment attribute.
1586 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1587 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1588 return Align;
1589
1590 // Otherwise, see if the declaration of the type had an attribute.
1591 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TagType>())
1592 return TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment();
1593
1594 return 0;
1595}
1596
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001597TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemerf8d38642014-07-30 08:42:33 +00001598 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1599 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1600 return I->second;
1601
1602 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1603 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1604 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
Rafael Espindolaeaa88c12014-07-30 04:40:23 +00001605 return TI;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001606}
1607
1608/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1609/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001610///
1611/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1612/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1613/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001614TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1615 uint64_t Width = 0;
1616 unsigned Align = 8;
1617 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001618 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001619#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1620#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001621#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001622#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001623#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1624 case Type::Class: \
1625 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1626 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001627#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001628 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001629
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001630 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1631 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001632 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1633 Width = 0;
1634 Align = 32;
1635 break;
1636
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001637 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001638 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001639 Width = 0;
1640 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1641 break;
1642
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001643 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001644 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001645
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001646 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001647 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001648 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001649 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001650 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1651 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001652 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1653 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001654 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001655 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001656 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001657 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001658 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001659 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001660 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1661 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001662 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001663 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1664 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001665 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001666 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001667 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001668 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001669 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1670 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1671 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1672 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001673 break;
1674 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001675
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001676 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001677 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001678 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001679 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001680 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1681 Width = 0;
1682 Align = 8;
1683 break;
1684
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001685 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001686 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1687 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001688 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001689 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1690 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1691 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001692 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001693 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1694 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001695 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001696 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1697 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001698 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1699 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001700 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001701 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001702 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1703 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001704 break;
1705 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001706 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1707 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001708 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001709 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001710 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001711 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1712 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001713 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001714 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001715 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001716 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1717 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001718 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001719 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001720 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001721 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1722 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001723 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001724 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001725 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001726 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1727 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001728 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001729 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1730 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1731 Width = 128;
1732 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1733 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001734 case BuiltinType::Half:
1735 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1736 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1737 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001738 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001739 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1740 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001741 break;
1742 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001743 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1744 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001745 break;
1746 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001747 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1748 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001749 break;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001750 case BuiltinType::Float128:
1751 Width = Target->getFloat128Width();
1752 Align = Target->getFloat128Align();
1753 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001754 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001755 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1756 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001757 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001758 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1759 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1760 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001761 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1762 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001763 break;
Yaxun Liu0bc4b2d2016-07-28 19:26:30 +00001764 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler: {
1765 auto AS = getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_constant);
1766 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1767 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001768 break;
Yaxun Liu0bc4b2d2016-07-28 19:26:30 +00001769 }
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001770 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001771 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
1772 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
1773 case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange:
1774 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001775 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1776 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1777 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1778 break;
Yaxun Liu99444cb2016-08-03 20:38:06 +00001779#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1780 case BuiltinType::Id:
1781#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
1782 {
1783 auto AS = getTargetAddressSpace(Target->getOpenCLImageAddrSpace());
1784 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1785 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1786 }
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001787 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001788 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001789 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001790 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1791 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001792 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001793 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001794 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1795 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001796 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1797 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001798 break;
1799 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001800 case Type::LValueReference:
1801 case Type::RValueReference: {
1802 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1803 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001804 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1805 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001806 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1807 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001808 break;
1809 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001810 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001811 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001812 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1813 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001814 break;
1815 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001816 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001817 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001818 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001819 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001820 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001821 case Type::Complex: {
1822 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1823 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001824 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1825 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1826 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001827 break;
1828 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001829 case Type::ObjCObject:
1830 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001831 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001832 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001833 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001834 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001835 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001836 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001837 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001838 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001839 break;
1840 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001841 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001842 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001843 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1844
1845 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001846 Width = 8;
1847 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001848 break;
1849 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001850
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001851 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1852 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1853 TypeInfo Info =
1854 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1855 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1856 Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1857 Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1858 }
1859 return Info;
1860 }
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001861
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001862 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001863 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1864 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001865 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001866 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001867 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001868 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001869 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001870
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001871 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001872 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1873 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001874
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001875 case Type::Auto: {
1876 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001877 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1878 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001879 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001880 }
1881
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001882 case Type::Paren:
1883 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1884
Manman Rene6be26c2016-09-13 17:25:08 +00001885 case Type::ObjCTypeParam:
1886 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
1887
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001888 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001889 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001890 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001891 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1892 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1893 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001894 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001895 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001896 AlignIsRequired = true;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001897 } else {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001898 Align = Info.Align;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001899 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1900 }
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001901 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001902 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001903 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001904
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001905 case Type::Elaborated:
1906 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001907
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001908 case Type::Attributed:
1909 return getTypeInfo(
1910 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1911
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001912 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001913 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001914 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1915 Width = Info.Width;
1916 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001917
1918 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1919 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1920 // favorable to atomic operations:
1921 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1922 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1923 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1924 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1925
1926 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001927 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1928 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001929 }
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00001930 break;
1931
1932 case Type::Pipe: {
1933 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<PipeType>(T)->getElementType());
1934 Width = Info.Width;
1935 Align = Info.Align;
1936 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001937
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001938 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001939
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001940 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001941 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001942}
1943
Alexey Bataev00396512015-07-02 03:40:19 +00001944unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
1945 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
1946 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32.
1947 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 ||
1948 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) &&
1949 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" &&
1950 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
1951 SimdAlign = 256;
1952 return SimdAlign;
1953}
1954
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001955/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1956CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1957 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1958}
1959
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001960/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1961int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1962 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1963}
1964
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001965/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1966/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001967CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001968 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001969}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001970CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001971 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001972}
1973
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001974/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001975/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001976CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001977 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001978}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001979CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001980 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001981}
1982
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001983/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1984/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1985/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1986/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001987unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001988 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1989 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001990
David Majnemere1544562015-04-24 01:25:05 +00001991 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1992
1993 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
1994 if (T->isMemberPointerType())
1995 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
1996
Andrey Turetskiydb6655f2016-02-10 11:58:46 +00001997 if (!Target->allowsLargerPreferedTypeAlignment())
1998 return ABIAlign;
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001999
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002000 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00002001 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002002 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00002003 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
2004 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002005 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00002006 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
2007 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00002008 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
2009 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00002010 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00002011 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002012
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00002013 return ABIAlign;
2014}
2015
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00002016/// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
2017/// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
2018/// value is specified.
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00002019unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const {
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00002020 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
2021}
2022
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00002023/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
2024/// to a global variable of the specified type.
2025unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
2026 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
2027}
2028
2029/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
2030/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
2031CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
2032 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
2033}
2034
David Majnemer08ef2ba2015-06-23 20:34:18 +00002035CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
2036 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
2037 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2038 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
2039 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
2040 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
2041 }
2042 return Offset;
2043}
2044
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002045/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
2046/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
2047/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
2048/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
2049/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00002050///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002051void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
2052 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00002053 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002054 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
2055 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
2056 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00002057 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
2058 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00002059 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00002060 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00002061 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00002062 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
2063 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
2064 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00002065}
2066
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002067/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
2068/// those inherited by it.
2069void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00002070 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002071 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00002072 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
2073 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00002074 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002075 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00002076 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002077
2078 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00002079 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
2080 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002081
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002082 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
2083 while (SD) {
2084 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
2085 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
2086 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002087 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00002088 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002089 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002090 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002091 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002092 // Insert the protocol.
2093 if (!Protocols.insert(
2094 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
2095 return;
2096
2097 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
2098 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002099 }
2100}
2101
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002102unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002103 unsigned count = 0;
2104 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00002105 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002106 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002107
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002108 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
2109 // includes synthesized ivars.
2110 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002111 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
2112
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00002113 return count;
2114}
2115
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00002116bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
2117 if (!E)
2118 return false;
2119
2120 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
2121 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
2122
2123 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
2124 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
2125 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2126 return true;
2127
2128 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
2129 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
2130
2131 return false;
2132}
2133
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002134/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
2135ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
2136 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2137 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2138 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2139 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002140 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002141}
2142/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
2143ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
2144 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2145 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2146 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2147 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002148 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002149}
2150
2151/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
2152void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2153 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2154 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2155 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2156}
2157/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
2158void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2159 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2160 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2161 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2162}
2163
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00002164const ObjCMethodDecl *
2165ASTContext::getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) const {
2166 return ObjCMethodRedecls.lookup(MD);
2167}
2168
2169void ASTContext::setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD,
2170 const ObjCMethodDecl *Redecl) {
2171 assert(!getObjCMethodRedeclaration(MD) && "MD already has a redeclaration");
2172 ObjCMethodRedecls[MD] = Redecl;
2173}
2174
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002175const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2176 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2177 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
2178 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002179 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002180 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
2181 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002182 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002183 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
2184 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002185 return IMD->getClassInterface();
2186
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002187 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002188}
2189
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002190/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
2191/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002192Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002193 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2194 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2195 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002196 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002197 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002198 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002199}
2200
2201/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
2202void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
2203 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002204 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2205 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002206 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
2207}
2208
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002209TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002210 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002211 if (!DataSize)
2212 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2213 else
2214 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002215 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002216
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002217 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2218 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2219 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2220 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00002221}
2222
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002223TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00002224 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002225 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00002226 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00002227 return DI;
2228}
2229
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002230const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002231ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002232 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002233}
2234
2235const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002236ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2237 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002238 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2239}
2240
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002241//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2242// Type creation/memoization methods
2243//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2244
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002245QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002246ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2247 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2248 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002249
2250 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2251 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002252 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002253 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002254 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2255 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2256 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002257 }
2258
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002259 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2260 QualType canon;
2261 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2262 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002263 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2264 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002265
2266 // Re-find the insert position.
2267 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2268 }
2269
2270 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2271 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2272 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002273}
2274
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002275QualType
2276ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002277 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2278 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002279 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002280
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002281 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2282 // into one ExtQuals node.
2283 QualifierCollector Quals;
2284 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002285
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002286 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2287 // another one.
2288 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2289 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2290 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002291
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002292 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002293}
2294
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002295QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002296 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002297 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002298 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002299 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002300
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002301 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2302 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002303 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002304 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2305 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2306 }
2307 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002308
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002309 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2310 // into one ExtQuals node.
2311 QualifierCollector Quals;
2312 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002313
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002314 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2315 // another one.
2316 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2317 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2318 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002319
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002320 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002321}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002322
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002323const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2324 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2325 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2326 return T;
2327
2328 QualType Result;
2329 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002330 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002331 } else {
2332 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2333 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2334 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002335 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002336 }
2337
2338 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2339}
2340
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002341void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2342 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002343 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2344 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002345 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2346 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002347 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002348 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2349 FD = Next;
2350 else
2351 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002352 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002353 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2354 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002355}
2356
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002357/// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2358/// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2359/// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2360/// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
2361static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2362 ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2363 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2364 // Might have some parens.
2365 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2366 return Context.getParenType(
2367 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2368
2369 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2370 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2371 return Context.getAttributedType(
2372 AT->getAttrKind(),
2373 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2374 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2375 ESI));
2376
2377 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2378 // specification.
2379 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2380 return Context.getFunctionType(
2381 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2382 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2383}
2384
2385void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2386 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2387 bool AsWritten) {
2388 // Update the type.
2389 QualType Updated =
2390 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2391 FD->setType(Updated);
2392
2393 if (!AsWritten)
2394 return;
2395
2396 // Update the type in the type source information too.
2397 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2398 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2399 // the type-as-written too.
2400 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2401 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2402
2403 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2404 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2405 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2406 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2407 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2408 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2409 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2410 }
2411}
2412
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002413/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2414/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002415QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002416 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2417 // structure.
2418 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2419 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002420
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002421 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002422 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2423 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002424
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002425 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2426 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2427 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002428 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002429 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002430
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002431 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2432 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002433 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002434 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002435 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002436 Types.push_back(New);
2437 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2438 return QualType(New, 0);
2439}
2440
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002441/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2442/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002443QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002444 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2445 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002446 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002447 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002448
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002449 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002450 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002451 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002452
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002453 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2454 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002455 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002456 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002457 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002458
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002459 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2460 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002461 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002462 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002463 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002464 Types.push_back(New);
2465 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002466 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002467}
2468
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002469QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2470 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2471 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002472 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002473 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2474 if (AT)
2475 return QualType(AT, 0);
2476
2477 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2478
2479 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2480 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002481 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002482
2483 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2484 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2485 Types.push_back(AT);
2486 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2487 return QualType(AT, 0);
2488}
2489
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002490QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2491 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2492
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002493 QualType Decayed;
2494
2495 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2496 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2497 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2498 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2499 // the array type derivation.
2500 if (T->isArrayType())
2501 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2502
2503 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2504 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2505 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2506 // in 6.3.2.1.
2507 if (T->isFunctionType())
2508 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2509
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002510 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2511 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002512 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002513 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2514 if (AT)
2515 return QualType(AT, 0);
2516
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002517 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2518
2519 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002520 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002521 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002522
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002523 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2524 Types.push_back(AT);
2525 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2526 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002527}
2528
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002529/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002530/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002531QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002532 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2533 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002534 // structure.
2535 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2536 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002537
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002538 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002539 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2540 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2541 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002542
2543 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002544 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2545 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002546 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002547 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002548
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002549 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2550 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2551 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002552 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002553 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002554 BlockPointerType *New
2555 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002556 Types.push_back(New);
2557 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2558 return QualType(New, 0);
2559}
2560
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002561/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2562/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002563QualType
2564ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002565 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2566 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2567
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002568 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2569 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002570 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002571 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002572
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002573 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002574 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2575 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002576 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002577
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002578 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2579
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002580 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2581 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2582 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002583 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2584 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2585 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002586
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002587 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002588 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2589 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002590 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002591 }
2592
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002593 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002594 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2595 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002596 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002597 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002598
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002599 return QualType(New, 0);
2600}
2601
2602/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2603/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002604QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002605 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2606 // structure.
2607 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002608 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002609
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002610 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002611 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2612 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2613 return QualType(RT, 0);
2614
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002615 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2616
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002617 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2618 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2619 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002620 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2621 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2622 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002623
2624 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2625 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2626 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002627 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002628 }
2629
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002630 RValueReferenceType *New
2631 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002632 Types.push_back(New);
2633 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002634 return QualType(New, 0);
2635}
2636
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002637/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2638/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002639QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002640 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2641 // structure.
2642 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2643 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2644
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002645 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002646 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2647 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2648 return QualType(PT, 0);
2649
2650 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2651 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2652 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002653 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002654 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2655
2656 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2657 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2658 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002659 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002660 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002661 MemberPointerType *New
2662 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002663 Types.push_back(New);
2664 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2665 return QualType(New, 0);
2666}
2667
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002668/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002669/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002670QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002671 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002672 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002673 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002674 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2675 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002676 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2677
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002678 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2679 // the target.
2680 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002681 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002682 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002683
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002684 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002685 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002686
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002687 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002688 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002689 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002690 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002691
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002692 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2693 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2694 QualType Canon;
2695 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2696 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002697 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002698 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002699 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002700
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002701 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002702 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002703 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002704 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002705 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002706
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002707 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002708 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002709 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002710 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002711 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002712}
2713
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002714/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2715/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2716/// sizes replaced with [*].
2717QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2718 // Vastly most common case.
2719 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002720
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002721 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002722
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002723 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002724 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002725 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2726#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2727#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2728#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2729#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2730 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2731
2732 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2733 case Type::Builtin:
2734 case Type::Complex:
2735 case Type::Vector:
2736 case Type::ExtVector:
2737 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2738 case Type::ObjCObject:
2739 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2740 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2741 case Type::Record:
2742 case Type::Enum:
2743 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2744 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2745 case Type::TypeOf:
2746 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002747 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002748 case Type::DependentName:
2749 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2750 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2751 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2752 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2753 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002754 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002755 case Type::PackExpansion:
2756 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2757
2758 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2759 // further decay.
2760 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2761 case Type::FunctionProto:
2762 case Type::BlockPointer:
2763 case Type::MemberPointer:
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00002764 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002765 return type;
2766
2767 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2768 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2769 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2770 // optimizations available here.
2771 case Type::Pointer:
2772 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2773 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2774 break;
2775
2776 case Type::LValueReference: {
2777 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2778 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2779 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2780 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2781 break;
2782 }
2783
2784 case Type::RValueReference: {
2785 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2786 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2787 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2788 break;
2789 }
2790
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002791 case Type::Atomic: {
2792 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2793 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2794 break;
2795 }
2796
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002797 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2798 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2799 result = getConstantArrayType(
2800 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2801 cat->getSize(),
2802 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2803 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2804 break;
2805 }
2806
2807 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2808 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2809 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2810 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2811 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2812 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2813 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2814 dat->getBracketsRange());
2815 break;
2816 }
2817
2818 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2819 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2820 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2821 result = getVariableArrayType(
2822 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002823 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002824 ArrayType::Normal,
2825 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2826 SourceRange());
2827 break;
2828 }
2829
2830 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2831 case Type::VariableArray: {
2832 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2833 result = getVariableArrayType(
2834 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002835 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002836 ArrayType::Star,
2837 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2838 vat->getBracketsRange());
2839 break;
2840 }
2841 }
2842
2843 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002844 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002845}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002846
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002847/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2848/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002849QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2850 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002851 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002852 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002853 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002854 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2855 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002856 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002857
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002858 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2859 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2860 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002861 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002862 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002863 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002864 }
2865
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002866 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002867 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002868
2869 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2870 Types.push_back(New);
2871 return QualType(New, 0);
2872}
2873
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002874/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2875/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002876/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002877QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2878 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002879 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002880 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2881 SourceRange brackets) const {
2882 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2883 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002884 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2885
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002886 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2887 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2888 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2889 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2890 if (!numElements) {
2891 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2892 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2893 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2894 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2895 brackets);
2896 Types.push_back(newType);
2897 return QualType(newType, 0);
2898 }
2899
2900 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2901 // also build a canonical type.
2902
2903 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2904
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002905 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002906 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002907 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002908 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002909 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002910
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002911 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2912 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2913 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002914
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002915 // If we don't have one, build one.
2916 if (!canonTy) {
2917 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002918 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002919 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2920 brackets);
2921 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2922 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002923 }
2924
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002925 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2926 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002927 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002928
David Majnemer16a74702015-07-24 05:54:19 +00002929 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size
2930 // expression, then just use that as our result.
2931 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType &&
2932 canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002933 return canon;
2934
2935 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2936 // of the element type.
2937 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2938 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2939 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2940 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2941 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2942 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002943}
2944
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002945QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002946 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002947 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002948 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002949 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002950
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002951 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002952 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2953 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2954 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002955
2956 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002957 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2958 // qualifiers off the element type.
2959 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002960
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002961 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2962 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002963 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002964 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002965 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002966
2967 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002968 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2969 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2970 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002971 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002972
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002973 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2974 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002975
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002976 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2977 Types.push_back(newType);
2978 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002979}
2980
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002981/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2982/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002983QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002984 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002985 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002986
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002987 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2988 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002989 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002990
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002991 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002992 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2993 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2994
2995 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2996 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2997 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002998 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002999 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003000
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003001 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3002 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003003 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003004 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003005 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003006 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003007 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3008 Types.push_back(New);
3009 return QualType(New, 0);
3010}
3011
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00003012/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003013/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003014QualType
3015ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00003016 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003017
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003018 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
3019 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00003020 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003021 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003022 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003023 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3024 return QualType(VTP, 0);
3025
3026 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3027 // so fill in the canonical type field.
3028 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003029 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00003030 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003031
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003032 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3033 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003034 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003035 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003036 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3037 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003038 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3039 Types.push_back(New);
3040 return QualType(New, 0);
3041}
3042
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003043QualType
3044ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
3045 Expr *SizeExpr,
3046 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003047 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003048 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003049 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003050
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003051 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003052 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
3053 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3054 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
3055 if (Canon) {
3056 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
3057 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003058 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3059 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
3060 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003061 } else {
3062 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
3063 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003064 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3065 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
3066 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003067
3068 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
3069 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3070 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
3071 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003072 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3073 } else {
3074 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
3075 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003076 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3077 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003078 }
3079 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003080
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00003081 Types.push_back(New);
3082 return QualType(New, 0);
3083}
3084
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003085/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
3086static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
3087 return T.isCanonical() &&
3088 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
3089 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
3090}
3091
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003092/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003093///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003094QualType
3095ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
3096 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003097 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3098 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00003099 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00003100 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003101
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003102 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003103 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003104 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003105 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003106
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003107 QualType Canonical;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003108 if (!isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy)) {
3109 Canonical =
3110 getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003111
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003112 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003113 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
3114 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003115 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003116 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003117
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003118 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003119 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, Info);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003120 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003121 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003122 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003123}
3124
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003125CanQualType
3126ASTContext::getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const {
3127 CanQualType CanResultType = getCanonicalType(ResultType);
3128
3129 // Canonical result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
3130 if (CanResultType.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
3131 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultType.getQualifiers();
3132 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
3133 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(
3134 getQualifiedType(CanResultType.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs));
3135 }
3136
3137 return CanResultType;
3138}
3139
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003140static bool isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(
3141 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI, bool NoexceptInType) {
3142 if (ESI.Type == EST_None)
3143 return true;
3144 if (!NoexceptInType)
3145 return false;
3146
3147 // C++17 onwards: exception specification is part of the type, as a simple
3148 // boolean "can this function type throw".
3149 if (ESI.Type == EST_BasicNoexcept)
3150 return true;
3151
3152 // A dynamic exception specification is canonical if it only contains pack
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003153 // expansions (so we can't tell whether it's non-throwing) and all its
3154 // contained types are canonical.
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003155 if (ESI.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3156 for (QualType ET : ESI.Exceptions)
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003157 if (!ET.isCanonical() || !ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003158 return false;
3159 return true;
3160 }
3161
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003162 // A noexcept(expr) specification is (possibly) canonical if expr is
3163 // value-dependent.
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003164 if (ESI.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept)
3165 return ESI.NoexceptExpr && ESI.NoexceptExpr->isValueDependent();
3166
3167 return false;
3168}
3169
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003170QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeInternal(
3171 QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
3172 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI, bool OnlyWantCanonical) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003173 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
3174
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003175 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3176 // structure.
3177 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3178 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
3179 *this, true);
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003180
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003181 QualType Canonical;
3182 bool Unique = false;
3183
3184 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3185 if (FunctionProtoType *FPT =
3186 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) {
3187 QualType Existing = QualType(FPT, 0);
3188
3189 // If we find a pre-existing equivalent FunctionProtoType, we can just reuse
3190 // it so long as our exception specification doesn't contain a dependent
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003191 // noexcept expression, or we're just looking for a canonical type.
3192 // Otherwise, we're going to need to create a type
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003193 // sugar node to hold the concrete expression.
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003194 if (OnlyWantCanonical || EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type != EST_ComputedNoexcept ||
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003195 EPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr == FPT->getNoexceptExpr())
3196 return Existing;
3197
3198 // We need a new type sugar node for this one, to hold the new noexcept
3199 // expression. We do no canonicalization here, but that's OK since we don't
3200 // expect to see the same noexcept expression much more than once.
3201 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Existing);
3202 Unique = true;
3203 }
3204
3205 bool NoexceptInType = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1z;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003206 bool IsCanonicalExceptionSpec =
3207 isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(EPI.ExceptionSpec, NoexceptInType);
3208
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003209 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003210 bool isCanonical = !Unique && IsCanonicalExceptionSpec &&
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003211 isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) && !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003212 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003213 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003214 isCanonical = false;
3215
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003216 if (OnlyWantCanonical)
3217 assert(isCanonical &&
3218 "given non-canonical parameters constructing canonical type");
3219
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003220 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it if we don't
3221 // already have it. The exception spec is only partially part of the
3222 // canonical type, and only in C++17 onwards.
3223 if (!isCanonical && Canonical.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003224 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003225 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3226 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003227 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003228
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003229 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003230 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003231
3232 if (IsCanonicalExceptionSpec) {
3233 // Exception spec is already OK.
3234 } else if (NoexceptInType) {
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003235 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ExceptionTypeStorage;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003236 switch (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type) {
3237 case EST_Unparsed: case EST_Unevaluated: case EST_Uninstantiated:
3238 // We don't know yet. It shouldn't matter what we pick here; no-one
3239 // should ever look at this.
3240 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003241 case EST_None: case EST_MSAny:
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003242 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3243 break;
3244
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003245 // A dynamic exception specification is almost always "not noexcept",
3246 // with the exception that a pack expansion might expand to no types.
3247 case EST_Dynamic: {
3248 bool AnyPacks = false;
3249 for (QualType ET : EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions) {
3250 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
3251 AnyPacks = true;
3252 ExceptionTypeStorage.push_back(getCanonicalType(ET));
3253 }
3254 if (!AnyPacks)
3255 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3256 else {
3257 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_Dynamic;
3258 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions = ExceptionTypeStorage;
3259 }
3260 break;
3261 }
3262
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003263 case EST_DynamicNone: case EST_BasicNoexcept:
3264 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_BasicNoexcept;
3265 break;
3266
3267 case EST_ComputedNoexcept:
3268 llvm::APSInt Value(1);
3269 auto *E = CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr;
3270 if (!E || !E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Value, *this, nullptr,
3271 /*IsEvaluated*/false)) {
3272 // This noexcept specification is invalid.
3273 // FIXME: Should this be able to happen?
3274 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3275 break;
3276 }
3277
3278 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
3279 Value.getBoolValue() ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_None;
3280 break;
3281 }
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003282 } else {
3283 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
3284 }
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003285
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003286 // Adjust the canonical function result type.
3287 CanQualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy);
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003288 Canonical =
3289 getFunctionTypeInternal(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI, true);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003290
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003291 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003292 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
3293 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003294 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003295 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003296
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003297 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
3298 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
3299 // - parameter types
3300 // - exception types
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003301 // - extended parameter information
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003302 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003303 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
3304 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003305 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003306 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003307
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003308 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3309 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3310 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00003311 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003312 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00003313 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003314 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003315 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003316 }
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003317
3318 // Put the ExtParameterInfos last. If all were equal, it would make
3319 // more sense to put these before the exception specification, because
3320 // it's much easier to skip past them compared to the elaborate switch
3321 // required to skip the exception specification. However, all is not
3322 // equal; ExtParameterInfos are used to model very uncommon features,
3323 // and it's better not to burden the more common paths.
3324 if (EPI.ExtParameterInfos) {
3325 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo);
3326 }
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003327
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003328 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00003329 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003330 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003331 Types.push_back(FTP);
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003332 if (!Unique)
3333 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003334 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003335}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00003336
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003337/// Return pipe type for the specified type.
3338QualType ASTContext::getPipeType(QualType T) const {
3339 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3340 PipeType::Profile(ID, T);
3341
3342 void *InsertPos = 0;
3343 if (PipeType *PT = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3344 return QualType(PT, 0);
3345
3346 // If the pipe element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3347 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3348 QualType Canonical;
3349 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3350 Canonical = getPipeType(getCanonicalType(T));
3351
3352 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3353 PipeType *NewIP = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3354 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3355 (void)NewIP;
3356 }
3357 PipeType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PipeType(T, Canonical);
3358 Types.push_back(New);
3359 PipeTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3360 return QualType(New, 0);
3361}
3362
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003363#ifndef NDEBUG
3364static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3365 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3366 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3367 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3368 return true;
3369 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3370 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3371 return true;
3372 return false;
3373}
3374#endif
3375
3376/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3377/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
3378QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003379 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003380 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3381 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3382 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003383 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003384 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3385 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3386 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3387 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003388 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003389 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003390 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3391 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003392 }
3393 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3394}
3395
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003396/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3397/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003398QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00003399 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003400 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003401
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003402 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003403 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003404
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003405 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3406 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3407
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003408 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003409 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003410 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003411 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003412 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003413 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003414 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003415 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00003416 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003417 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3418 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3419 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00003420 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003421 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003422
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003423 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003424}
3425
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00003426/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003427/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003428QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003429ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3430 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003431 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003432
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003433 if (Canonical.isNull())
3434 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003435 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003436 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003437 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3438 Types.push_back(newType);
3439 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00003440}
3441
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003442QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003443 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3444
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003445 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003446 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3447 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3448
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003449 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3450 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3451 Types.push_back(newType);
3452 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003453}
3454
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003455QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003456 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3457
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003458 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003459 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3460 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3461
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003462 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3463 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3464 Types.push_back(newType);
3465 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003466}
3467
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003468QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3469 QualType modifiedType,
3470 QualType equivalentType) {
3471 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3472 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3473
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003474 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003475 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3476 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3477
3478 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3479 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3480 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3481
3482 Types.push_back(type);
3483 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3484
3485 return QualType(type, 0);
3486}
3487
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003488/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3489QualType
3490ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003491 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003492 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003493 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3494
3495 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3496 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003497 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003498 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3499 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3500
3501 if (!SubstParm) {
3502 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3503 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3504 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3505 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3506 }
3507
3508 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3509}
3510
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003511/// \brief Retrieve a
3512QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3513 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3514 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3515#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003516 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3517 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3518 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003519 }
3520#endif
3521
3522 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3523 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003524 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003525 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3526 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3527 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3528
3529 QualType Canon;
3530 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3531 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3532 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3533 ArgPack);
3534 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3535 }
3536
3537 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3538 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3539 ArgPack);
3540 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3541 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3542 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3543}
3544
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003545/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003546/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003547/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003548QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003549 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003550 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003551 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003552 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003553 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003554 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003555 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3556
3557 if (TypeParm)
3558 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003559
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003560 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003561 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003562 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003563
3564 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3565 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3566 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3567 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003568 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003569 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3570 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003571
3572 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3573 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3574
3575 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3576}
3577
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003578TypeSourceInfo *
3579ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3580 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3581 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003582 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003583 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3584 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003585 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003586
3587 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003588 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3589 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003590 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003591 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3592 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3593 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3594 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3595 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3596 return DI;
3597}
3598
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003599QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003600ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003601 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003602 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003603 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3604 "No dependent template names here!");
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003605
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003606 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003607 ArgVec.reserve(Args.size());
3608 for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg : Args.arguments())
3609 ArgVec.push_back(Arg.getArgument());
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003610
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003611 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec, Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003612}
3613
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003614#ifndef NDEBUG
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003615static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) {
3616 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3617 if (Arg.isPackExpansion())
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003618 return true;
3619
3620 return true;
3621}
3622#endif
3623
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003624QualType
3625ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003626 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003627 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003628 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3629 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003630 // Look through qualified template names.
3631 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3632 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003633
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003634 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003635 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3636 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003637 QualType CanonType;
3638 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3639 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3640 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003641 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3642 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003643 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args)) &&
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003644 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3645 IsTypeAlias = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003646 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args);
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003647 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003648
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003649 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3650 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3651 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003652 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003653 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * Args.size() +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003654 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003655 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003656 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003657 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, CanonType,
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003658 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003659
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003660 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003661 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003662}
3663
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003664QualType ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(
3665 TemplateName Template, ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003666 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3667 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003668
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003669 // Look through qualified template names.
3670 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3671 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003672
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003673 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3674 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003675 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003676 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003677 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003678 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3679 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Arg));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003680
3681 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3682 // exists.
3683 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3684 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003685 CanonArgs, *this);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003686
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003687 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003688 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3689 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3690
3691 if (!Spec) {
3692 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3693 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3694 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3695 TypeAlignment);
3696 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003697 CanonArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003698 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003699 Types.push_back(Spec);
3700 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3701 }
3702
3703 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3704 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3705 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3706}
3707
3708QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003709ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3710 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003711 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003712 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003713 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003714
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003715 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003716 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003717 if (T)
3718 return QualType(T, 0);
3719
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003720 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3721 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3722 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003723 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3724 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003725 (void)CheckT;
3726 }
3727
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003728 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003729 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003730 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003731 return QualType(T, 0);
3732}
3733
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003734QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003735ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003736 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3737 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3738
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003739 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003740 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3741 if (T)
3742 return QualType(T, 0);
3743
3744 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3745 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3746 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3747 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3748 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3749 (void)CheckT;
3750 }
3751
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003752 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003753 Types.push_back(T);
3754 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3755 return QualType(T, 0);
3756}
3757
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003758QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3759 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3760 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003761 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003762 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3763 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003764 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3765 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3766 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3767
3768 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3769 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003770 }
3771
3772 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003773 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003774
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003775 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003776 DependentNameType *T
3777 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003778 if (T)
3779 return QualType(T, 0);
3780
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003781 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003782 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003783 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003784 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003785}
3786
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003787QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003788ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3789 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003790 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003791 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003792 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003793 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003794 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003795 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3796 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003797 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name, ArgCopy);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003798}
3799
3800QualType
3801ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3802 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3803 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3804 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003805 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003806 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3807 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003808
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003809 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003810 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003811 Name, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003812
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003813 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003814 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3815 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003816 if (T)
3817 return QualType(T, 0);
3818
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003819 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003820
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003821 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3822 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3823
3824 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003825 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003826 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003827 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3828 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3829 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3830 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003831 }
3832
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003833 QualType Canon;
3834 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3835 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003836 Name,
3837 CanonArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003838
3839 // Find the insert position again.
3840 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3841 }
3842
3843 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3844 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3845 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003846 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003847 Name, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003848 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003849 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003850 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003851}
3852
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003853QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003854 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003855 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003856 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003857
3858 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3859 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003860 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003861 PackExpansionType *T
3862 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3863 if (T)
3864 return QualType(T, 0);
3865
3866 QualType Canon;
3867 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003868 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3869 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3870 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3871 // parameters.
3872 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003873 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003874
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003875 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3876 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3877 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3878 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003879 }
3880
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003881 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3882 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003883 Types.push_back(T);
3884 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003885 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003886}
3887
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003888/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3889/// alphabetically.
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003890static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
3891 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
3892 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003893}
3894
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00003895static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols) {
3896 if (Protocols.empty()) return true;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003897
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003898 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3899 return false;
3900
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00003901 for (unsigned i = 1; i != Protocols.size(); ++i)
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003902 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003903 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003904 return false;
3905 return true;
3906}
3907
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003908static void
3909SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &Protocols) {
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003910 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003911 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end(), CmpProtocolNames);
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003912
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003913 // Canonicalize.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003914 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *&P : Protocols)
3915 P = P->getCanonicalDecl();
3916
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003917 // Remove duplicates.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003918 auto ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end());
3919 Protocols.erase(ProtocolsEnd, Protocols.end());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003920}
3921
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003922QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3923 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003924 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003925 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, { },
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003926 llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
3927 /*isKindOf=*/false);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003928}
3929
3930QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
3931 QualType baseType,
3932 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003933 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
3934 bool isKindOf) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003935 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
3936 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003937 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
3938 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003939 return baseType;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003940
3941 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003942 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003943 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003944 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003945 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3946 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003947
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003948 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
3949 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
3950 // type.
3951 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
3952 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
3953 if (auto baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
3954 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
3955 }
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003956
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003957 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
3958 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
3959 // canonicalized.
3960 QualType canonical;
3961 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(),
3962 effectiveTypeArgs.end(),
3963 [&](QualType type) {
3964 return type.isCanonical();
3965 });
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00003966 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003967 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
3968 // Determine the canonical type arguments.
3969 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
3970 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
3971 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
3972 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
3973 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
3974 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
3975 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003976 } else {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003977 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003978 }
3979
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003980 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
3981 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
3982 if (!protocolsSorted) {
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003983 canonProtocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
3984 SortAndUniqueProtocols(canonProtocolsVec);
3985 canonProtocols = canonProtocolsVec;
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003986 } else {
3987 canonProtocols = protocols;
3988 }
3989
3990 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003991 canonProtocols, isKindOf);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003992
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003993 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003994 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3995 }
3996
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003997 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3998 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3999 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
4000 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004001 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004002 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
4003 isKindOf);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004004
4005 Types.push_back(T);
4006 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4007 return QualType(T, 0);
4008}
4009
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004010/// Apply Objective-C protocol qualifiers to the given type.
4011/// If this is for the canonical type of a type parameter, we can apply
4012/// protocol qualifiers on the ObjCObjectPointerType.
4013QualType
4014ASTContext::applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(QualType type,
4015 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, bool &hasError,
4016 bool allowOnPointerType) const {
4017 hasError = false;
4018
Manman Renc5705ba2016-09-13 17:41:05 +00004019 if (const ObjCTypeParamType *objT =
4020 dyn_cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
4021 return getObjCTypeParamType(objT->getDecl(), protocols);
4022 }
4023
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004024 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectPointerType.
4025 if (allowOnPointerType) {
4026 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr =
4027 dyn_cast<ObjCObjectPointerType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
4028 const ObjCObjectType *objT = objPtr->getObjectType();
4029 // Merge protocol lists and construct ObjCObjectType.
4030 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> protocolsVec;
4031 protocolsVec.append(objT->qual_begin(),
4032 objT->qual_end());
4033 protocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
4034 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols = protocolsVec;
4035 type = getObjCObjectType(
4036 objT->getBaseType(),
4037 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
4038 protocols,
4039 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
4040 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4041 }
4042 }
4043
4044 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectType.
4045 if (const ObjCObjectType *objT = dyn_cast<ObjCObjectType>(type.getTypePtr())){
4046 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
4047 // known to conform.
4048
4049 return getObjCObjectType(objT->getBaseType(),
4050 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
4051 protocols,
4052 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
4053 }
4054
4055 // If the canonical type is ObjCObjectType, ...
4056 if (type->isObjCObjectType()) {
4057 // Silently overwrite any existing protocol qualifiers.
4058 // TODO: determine whether that's the right thing to do.
4059
4060 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
4061 // known to conform.
4062 return getObjCObjectType(type, { }, protocols, false);
4063 }
4064
4065 // id<protocol-list>
4066 if (type->isObjCIdType()) {
4067 const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4068 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, { }, protocols,
4069 objPtr->isKindOfType());
4070 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4071 }
4072
4073 // Class<protocol-list>
4074 if (type->isObjCClassType()) {
4075 const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4076 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, { }, protocols,
4077 objPtr->isKindOfType());
4078 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4079 }
4080
4081 hasError = true;
4082 return type;
4083}
4084
Manman Rene6be26c2016-09-13 17:25:08 +00004085QualType
4086ASTContext::getObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *Decl,
4087 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
4088 QualType Canonical) const {
4089 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4090 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4091 ObjCTypeParamType::Profile(ID, Decl, protocols);
4092 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4093 if (ObjCTypeParamType *TypeParam =
4094 ObjCTypeParamTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4095 return QualType(TypeParam, 0);
4096
4097 if (Canonical.isNull()) {
4098 // We canonicalize to the underlying type.
4099 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
4100 if (!protocols.empty()) {
4101 // Apply the protocol qualifers.
4102 bool hasError;
4103 Canonical = applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(Canonical, protocols, hasError,
4104 true/*allowOnPointerType*/);
4105 assert(!hasError && "Error when apply protocol qualifier to bound type");
4106 }
4107 }
4108
4109 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCTypeParamType);
4110 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
4111 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
4112 ObjCTypeParamType *newType = new (mem)
4113 ObjCTypeParamType(Decl, Canonical, protocols);
4114
4115 Types.push_back(newType);
4116 ObjCTypeParamTypes.InsertNode(newType, InsertPos);
4117 return QualType(newType, 0);
4118}
4119
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004120/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
4121/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
4122/// list.
4123bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
4124 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
4125 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4126 return false;
4127
4128 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
4129 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004130 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004131 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
4132 return false;
4133 }
4134 return true;
4135 }
4136 return false;
4137}
4138
4139/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
4140/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
4141/// of protocols.
4142bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
4143 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
4144 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4145 return false;
4146 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4147 if (!OPT)
4148 return false;
4149 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
4150 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00004151 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
4152 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
4153 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
4154 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00004155 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
4156 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
4157 bool Conforms = false;
4158 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
4159 Conforms = false;
4160 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
4161 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
4162 Conforms = true;
4163 break;
4164 }
4165 }
4166 if (!Conforms)
4167 break;
4168 }
4169 if (Conforms)
4170 return true;
4171
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004172 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004173 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
4174 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004175 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00004176 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004177 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004178 break;
4179 }
4180 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00004181 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004182 }
4183 return true;
4184}
4185
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004186/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
4187/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004188QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004189 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4190 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
4191
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004192 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004193 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
4194 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4195 return QualType(QT, 0);
4196
4197 // Find the canonical object type.
4198 QualType Canonical;
4199 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
4200 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
4201
4202 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004203 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4204 }
4205
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00004206 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004207 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
4208 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
4209 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004210
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004211 Types.push_back(QType);
4212 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004213 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004214}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004215
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004216/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4217/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00004218QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
4219 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004220 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
4221 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004222
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00004223 if (PrevDecl) {
4224 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
4225 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
4226 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4227 }
4228
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00004229 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
4230 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
4231 Decl = Def;
4232
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004233 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
4234 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
4235 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
4236 Types.push_back(T);
4237 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00004238}
4239
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004240/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
4241/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004242/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004243/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004244/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004245QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004246 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004247 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
4248 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4249 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004250
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004251 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004252 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
4253 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4254 if (Canon) {
4255 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
4256 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004257 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004258 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00004259 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004260 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004261 Canon
4262 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004263 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4264 toe = Canon;
4265 }
4266 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004267 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004268 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004269 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004270 Types.push_back(toe);
4271 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00004272}
4273
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004274/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004275/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004276/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004277/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
4278/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004279QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004280 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004281 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004282 Types.push_back(tot);
4283 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00004284}
4285
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004286/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
4287/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
4288/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
4289/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00004290QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004291 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004292
4293 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00004294 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004295 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
4296 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00004297 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004298 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4299 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004300
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004301 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004302 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
4303 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004304 if (!Canon) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004305 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004306 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004307 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004308 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004309 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4310 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004311 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004312 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4313 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004314 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00004315 Types.push_back(dt);
4316 return QualType(dt, 0);
4317}
4318
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004319/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
4320/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
4321QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
4322 QualType UnderlyingType,
4323 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
4324 const {
Vassil Vassilevbab6f962016-03-30 22:18:29 +00004325 UnaryTransformType *ut = nullptr;
4326
4327 if (BaseType->isDependentType()) {
4328 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4329 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4330 DependentUnaryTransformType::Profile(ID, getCanonicalType(BaseType), Kind);
4331
4332 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4333 DependentUnaryTransformType *Canon
4334 = DependentUnaryTransformTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4335
4336 if (!Canon) {
4337 // Build a new, canonical __underlying_type(type) type.
4338 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4339 DependentUnaryTransformType(*this, getCanonicalType(BaseType),
4340 Kind);
4341 DependentUnaryTransformTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4342 }
4343 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4344 QualType(), Kind,
4345 QualType(Canon, 0));
4346 } else {
4347 QualType CanonType = getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType);
4348 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4349 UnderlyingType, Kind,
4350 CanonType);
4351 }
4352 Types.push_back(ut);
4353 return QualType(ut, 0);
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004354}
4355
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004356/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
4357/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
4358/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004359QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004360 bool IsDependent) const {
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004361 if (DeducedType.isNull() && Keyword == AutoTypeKeyword::Auto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004362 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004363
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004364 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004365 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004366 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004367 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004368 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4369 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004370
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00004371 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004372 Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004373 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004374 Types.push_back(AT);
4375 if (InsertPos)
4376 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
4377 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00004378}
4379
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004380/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
4381/// the given value type.
4382QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
4383 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
4384 // structure.
4385 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4386 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
4387
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004388 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004389 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4390 return QualType(AT, 0);
4391
4392 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
4393 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
4394 QualType Canonical;
4395 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
4396 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
4397
4398 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4399 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004400 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004401 }
4402 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
4403 Types.push_back(New);
4404 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4405 return QualType(New, 0);
4406}
4407
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004408/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
4409QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
4410 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004411 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004412 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::Auto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004413 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004414 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004415 return AutoDeductTy;
4416}
4417
4418/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
4419QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
4420 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
4421 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
4422 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
4423 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
4424}
4425
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004426/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4427/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004428QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00004429 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00004430 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
4431 // away const? mutable?
4432 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004433}
4434
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004435/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
4436/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
4437/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00004438CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004439 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00004440}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004441
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004442/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4443CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
4444 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
4445}
4446
4447/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4448CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
4449 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
4450}
4451
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00004452/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
4453/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4454QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
4455 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4456 return WCharTy;
4457}
4458
4459/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
4460/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4461QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
4462 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4463 return UnsignedIntTy;
4464}
4465
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00004466QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
4467 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
4468}
4469
4470QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
4471 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
4472}
4473
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004474/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004475/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
4476QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004477 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004478}
4479
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00004480/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
4481/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
4482QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
4483 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
4484}
4485
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004486//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4487// Type Operators
4488//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4489
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004490CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004491 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
4492 // qualifiers.
4493 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00004494 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004495 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004496 QualType Result;
4497 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
4498 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
4499 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
4500 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
4501 } else {
4502 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
4503 }
4504
4505 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
4506}
4507
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004508QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
4509 Qualifiers &quals) {
4510 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
4511
4512 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
4513 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
4514 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
4515 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
4516 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004517 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004518
4519 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004520 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004521 quals = splitType.Quals;
4522 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004523 }
4524
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004525 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4526 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4527 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4528
4529 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4530 // can just use the results in splitType.
4531 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4532 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004533 quals = splitType.Quals;
4534 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004535 }
4536
4537 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4538 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004539 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004540
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004541 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004542 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004543 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4544 }
4545
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004546 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004547 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004548 }
4549
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004550 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004551 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004552 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004553 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4554 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4555 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4556 }
4557
4558 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004559 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004560 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4561 SourceRange());
4562}
4563
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004564/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
4565/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4566/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4567/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4568/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4569/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4570/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4571/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4572bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4573 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4574 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4575 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4576 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4577 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4578 return true;
4579 }
4580
4581 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4582 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4583 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4584 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4585 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4586 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4587 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4588 return true;
4589 }
4590
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004591 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004592 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4593 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4594 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4595 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4596 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4597 return true;
4598 }
4599 }
4600
4601 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4602
4603 return false;
4604}
4605
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004606DeclarationNameInfo
4607ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4608 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004609 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4610 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4611 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004612 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004613 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4614 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004615
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004616 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4617 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4618 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4619 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4620 }
4621
4622 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4623 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004624 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004625 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004626 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4627 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004628 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004629 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4630 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4631 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4632 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4633 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4634 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004635 }
4636 }
4637
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004638 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4639 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4640 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4641 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4642 NameLoc);
4643 }
4644
4645 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4646 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4647 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4648 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4649 NameLoc);
4650 }
4651 }
4652
4653 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004654}
4655
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004656TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004657 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4658 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4659 case TemplateName::Template: {
4660 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004661 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004662 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004663 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4664
4665 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004666 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004667 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004668
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004669 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4670 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004671
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004672 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4673 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4674 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4675 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4676 }
4677
4678 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4679 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4680 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4681 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4682 }
4683
4684 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4685 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4686 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4687 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4688 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4689 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4690 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4691 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4692 }
4693 }
4694
4695 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004696}
4697
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004698bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4699 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4700 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4701 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4702}
4703
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004704TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004705ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004706 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4707 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4708 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004709
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004710 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004711 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004712
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004713 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004714 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
David Blaikie952a9b12014-10-17 18:00:12 +00004715 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004716 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004717
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004718 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4719 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4720 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4721
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004722 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4723 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004724
4725 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4726 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4727 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004728 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004729
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004730 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004731 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004732
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004733 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004734 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004735
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004736 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004737 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4738 return Arg;
4739
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004740 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4741 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004742 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004743 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004744 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4745 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4746 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004747
Benjamin Kramercce63472015-08-05 09:40:22 +00004748 return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size()));
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004749 }
4750 }
4751
4752 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004753 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004754}
4755
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004756NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004757ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004758 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004759 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004760
4761 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4762 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4763 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004764 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004765 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4766 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4767
4768 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4769 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4770 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004771 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004772 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4773
4774 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4775 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4776 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004777 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004778 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4779 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004780
4781 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4782 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4783 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004784
4785 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4786 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4787 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4788 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4789 // types, e.g.,
4790 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4791 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004792 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4793 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004794 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004795
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004796 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4797 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4798 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004799 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4800 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004801 }
4802
4803 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
Nikola Smiljanic67860242014-09-26 00:28:20 +00004804 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
4805 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004806 return NNS;
4807 }
4808
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004809 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004810}
4811
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004812const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004813 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004814 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004815 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4816 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4817 return AT;
4818 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004819
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004820 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004821 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004822 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004823
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004824 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004825 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4826 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004827
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004828 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4829 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004830 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004831
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004832 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004833 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004834
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004835 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004836 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004837 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004838 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004839
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004840 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4841 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004842 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004843
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004844 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4845 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4846 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004847 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004848 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4849 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4850 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004851 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004852
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004853 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004854 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4855 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004856 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004857 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004858 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004859 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004860 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004861
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004862 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004863 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004864 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004865 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004866 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004867 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004868}
4869
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004870QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004871 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4872 return getDecayedType(T);
4873 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004874}
4875
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004876QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004877 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4878 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4879 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4880}
4881
David Majnemerd09a51c2015-03-03 01:50:05 +00004882QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
4883 // C++ [except.throw]p3:
4884 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
4885 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
4886 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
4887 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
4888 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
4889 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4890 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4891 T = getDecayedType(T);
4892 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4893}
4894
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004895/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4896/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4897/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4898/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4899///
4900/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004901QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004902 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4903 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4904 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4905 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4906 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4907 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004908
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004909 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004910
4911 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004912 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004913}
4914
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004915QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4916 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004917}
4918
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004919QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4920 Qualifiers qs;
4921 while (true) {
4922 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004923 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004924 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004925
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004926 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004927 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004928 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004929
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004930 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004931}
4932
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004933/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004934uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004935ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4936 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4937 do {
4938 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004939 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4940 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004941 } while (CA);
4942 return ElementCount;
4943}
4944
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004945/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4946/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004947static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004948 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004949 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004950
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004951 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4952 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004953 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004954 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004955 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4956 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4957 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00004958 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Float128Rank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004959 }
4960}
4961
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004962/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4963/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004964/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4965/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004966QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4967 QualType Domain) const {
4968 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4969 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4970 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004971 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004972 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4973 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4974 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00004975 case Float128Rank: return Float128ComplexTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004976 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004977 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004978
4979 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4980 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004981 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004982 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4983 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4984 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00004985 case Float128Rank: return Float128Ty;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004986 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004987 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004988}
4989
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004990/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4991/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4992/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004993/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004994int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004995 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4996 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004997
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004998 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004999 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005000 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00005001 return 1;
5002 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005003}
5004
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005005/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
5006/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
5007/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00005008unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00005009 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00005010
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005011 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005012 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005013 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005014 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005015 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5016 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5017 case BuiltinType::SChar:
5018 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005019 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005020 case BuiltinType::Short:
5021 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005022 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005023 case BuiltinType::Int:
5024 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005025 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005026 case BuiltinType::Long:
5027 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005028 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005029 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
5030 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005031 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00005032 case BuiltinType::Int128:
5033 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
5034 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005035 }
5036}
5037
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005038/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
5039/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
5040///
5041/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
5042/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005043QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00005044 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
5045 return QualType();
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005046
5047 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
5048 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
5049 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
5050
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00005051 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005052 if (!Field)
5053 return QualType();
5054
5055 QualType FT = Field->getType();
5056
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005057 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005058 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005059 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
5060 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
5061 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
5062 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
5063 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
5064 // promotion applies to it.
5065 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
5066 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
5067 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
5068 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
5069 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
5070 //
5071 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
5072 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005073 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
5074 return IntTy;
5075
5076 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
5077 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
5078
5079 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005080 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
5081 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
5082 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
5083 // into their semantics in some cases).
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005084 return QualType();
5085}
5086
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005087/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
5088/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
5089/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005090QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005091 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
5092 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00005093 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
5094 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00005095
5096 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5097 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
5098 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
5099 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
5100 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
5101 // unsigned long long int [...]
5102 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
5103 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
5104 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
5105 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
5106 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
5107 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
5108 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
5109 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
5110 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
5111 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
5112 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
5113 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
5114 (FromSize == ToSize &&
5115 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
5116 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
5117 }
5118 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
5119 }
5120 }
5121
5122 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005123 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
5124 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00005125 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
5126 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005127 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
5128 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
5129}
5130
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00005131/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
5132/// type and returns its ownership.
5133Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
5134 while (!T.isNull()) {
5135 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
5136 return T.getObjCLifetime();
5137 if (T->isArrayType())
5138 T = getBaseElementType(T);
5139 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
5140 T = PT->getPointeeType();
5141 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00005142 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00005143 else
5144 break;
5145 }
5146
5147 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
5148}
5149
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005150static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
5151 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
5152 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
5153 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
5154 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005155 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005156}
5157
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005158/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005159/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005160/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005161int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00005162 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
5163 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005164
5165 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
5166 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
5167 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
5168 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
5169 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
5170
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005171 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005172
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005173 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
5174 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005175
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005176 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
5177 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005178
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005179 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
5180 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
5181 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
5182 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005183
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005184 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
5185 if (LHSUnsigned) {
5186 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
5187 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
5188 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005189
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005190 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
5191 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005192 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005193 return -1;
5194 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005195
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005196 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
5197 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
5198 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005199
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005200 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
5201 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005202 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005203 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005204}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005205
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005206TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringDecl() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005207 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005208 assert(!CFConstantStringTagDecl &&
5209 "tag and typedef should be initialized together");
5210 CFConstantStringTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__NSConstantString_tag");
5211 CFConstantStringTagDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00005212
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00005213 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005214 const char *FieldNames[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005215
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005216 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005217 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005218 FieldNames[0] = "isa";
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00005219 // int flags;
5220 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005221 FieldNames[1] = "flags";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005222 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005223 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005224 FieldNames[2] = "str";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005225 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005226 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005227 FieldNames[3] = "length";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005228
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005229 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00005230 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005231 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTagDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00005232 SourceLocation(),
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005233 SourceLocation(),
5234 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005235 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5236 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00005237 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00005238 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005239 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005240 CFConstantStringTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00005241 }
5242
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005243 CFConstantStringTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5244 // This type is designed to be compatible with NSConstantString, but cannot
5245 // use the same name, since NSConstantString is an interface.
5246 auto tagType = getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTagDecl);
5247 CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
5248 buildImplicitTypedef(tagType, "__NSConstantString");
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005249 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005250
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00005251 return CFConstantStringTypeDecl;
5252}
5253
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005254RecordDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringTagDecl() const {
5255 if (!CFConstantStringTagDecl)
5256 getCFConstantStringDecl(); // Build the tag and the typedef.
5257 return CFConstantStringTagDecl;
5258}
5259
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00005260// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
5261QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005262 return getTypedefType(getCFConstantStringDecl());
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00005263}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00005264
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00005265QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
5266 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005267 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00005268 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
5269 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
5270 }
5271 return ObjCSuperType;
5272}
5273
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00005274void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005275 const TypedefType *TD = T->getAs<TypedefType>();
5276 assert(TD && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
5277 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = cast<TypedefDecl>(TD->getDecl());
5278 auto TagType =
5279 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<RecordType>();
5280 assert(TagType && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
5281 CFConstantStringTagDecl = TagType->getDecl();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00005282}
5283
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005284QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005285 if (BlockDescriptorType)
5286 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
5287
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005288 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005289 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005290 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
5291 RD->startDefinition();
5292
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005293 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5294 UnsignedLongTy,
5295 UnsignedLongTy,
5296 };
5297
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005298 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005299 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005300 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005301 };
5302
5303 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005304 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5305 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005306 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5307 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005308 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005309 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005310 }
5311
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005312 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005313
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005314 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005315
5316 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
5317}
5318
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005319QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005320 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
5321 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5322
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005323 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005324 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005325 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
5326 RD->startDefinition();
5327
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005328 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5329 UnsignedLongTy,
5330 UnsignedLongTy,
5331 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
5332 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
5333 };
5334
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005335 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005336 "reserved",
5337 "Size",
5338 "CopyFuncPtr",
5339 "DestroyFuncPtr"
5340 };
5341
5342 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005343 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5344 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005345 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5346 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005347 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005348 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005349 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005350 }
5351
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005352 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005353
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005354 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005355 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5356}
5357
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005358/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
5359/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
5360/// in buildByrefHelpers.
5361bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
5362 const VarDecl *D) {
5363 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
5364 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
5365 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
5366
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005367 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00005368 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005369
5370 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
5371
5372 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
5373
5374 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
5375 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005376 switch (lifetime) {
5377 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
5378
5379 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
5380 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
5381 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
5382 return false;
5383
5384 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
5385 // byref routines.
5386 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
5387 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
5388 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
5389 return true;
5390 }
5391 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
5392 }
5393 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
5394 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005395}
5396
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005397bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
5398 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
5399 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
5400
5401 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
5402 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
5403 return false;
5404
5405 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00005406 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005407 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
5408 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005409 } else if ((LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime())) {
5410 // Honor the ARC qualifiers.
5411 } else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
5412 // The MRR rule.
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005413 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005414 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005415 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005416 }
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005417 return true;
5418}
5419
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005420TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
5421 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005422 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
5423 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005424 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
5425}
5426
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005427// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
5428// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00005429static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005430 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00005431 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
5432 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005433
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005434 return false;
5435}
5436
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005437/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005438/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005439CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005440 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
5441 return CharUnits::Zero();
5442
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005443 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005444
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005445 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00005446 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005447 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005448 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
5449 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005450 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005451 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005452}
5453
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005454bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00005455 return getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
5456 VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
David Majnemerfac52432015-10-19 23:22:49 +00005457 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5458 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005459}
5460
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005461ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind
5462ASTContext::getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(const VarDecl *VD) const {
5463 if (!VD->isInline())
5464 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None;
5465
5466 // In almost all cases, it's a weak definition.
5467 auto *First = VD->getFirstDecl();
5468 if (!First->isConstexpr() || First->isInlineSpecified() ||
5469 !VD->isStaticDataMember())
5470 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak;
5471
5472 // If there's a file-context declaration in this translation unit, it's a
5473 // non-discardable definition.
5474 for (auto *D : VD->redecls())
5475 if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFileContext())
5476 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong;
5477
5478 // If we've not seen one yet, we don't know.
5479 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown;
5480}
5481
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005482static inline
5483std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
5484 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005485}
5486
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005487/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005488/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005489std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
5490 std::string S;
5491
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005492 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
5493 QualType BlockTy =
5494 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5495 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005496 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005497 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
5498 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
5499 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005500 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005501 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005502 // Compute size of all parameters.
5503 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5504 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5505 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005506 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5507 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005508 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00005509 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005510 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00005511 if (sz.isZero())
5512 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005513 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005514 ParmOffset += sz;
5515 }
5516 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005517 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005518 // Block pointer and offset.
5519 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005520
5521 // Argument types.
5522 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005523 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005524 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5525 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5526 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5527 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5528 // elements.
5529 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5530 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5531 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5532 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005533 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005534 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
5535 S, true /*Extended*/);
5536 else
5537 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005538 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005539 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005540 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005541
5542 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005543}
5544
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005545bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005546 std::string& S) {
5547 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005548 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005549 CharUnits ParmOffset;
5550 // Compute size of all parameters.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005551 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005552 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005553 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005554 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005555 continue;
5556
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005557 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005558 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005559 ParmOffset += sz;
5560 }
5561 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5562 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
5563
5564 // Argument types.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005565 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005566 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5567 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5568 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5569 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5570 // elements.
5571 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5572 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5573 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5574 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5575 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5576 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5577 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5578 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005579
5580 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005581}
5582
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005583/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5584/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5585/// block object types.
5586void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5587 QualType T, std::string& S,
5588 bool Extended) const {
5589 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5590 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5591 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005592 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005593 true /*OutermostType*/,
5594 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
5595 false /*StructField*/,
5596 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
5597 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
5598}
5599
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005600/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005601/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005602bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005603 std::string& S,
5604 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005605 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005606 // Encode return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005607 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5608 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005609 // Compute size of all parameters.
5610 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5611 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5612 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005613 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005614 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
5615 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005616 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005617 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005618 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00005619 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005620 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005621 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005622 continue;
5623
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005624 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5625 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005626 ParmOffset += sz;
5627 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005628 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005629 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005630 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005631
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005632 // Argument types.
5633 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005634 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005635 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005636 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005637 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00005638 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005639 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5640 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5641 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00005642 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005643 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5644 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5645 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005646 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5647 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005648 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005649 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005650 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005651
5652 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005653}
5654
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005655ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
5656ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
5657 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5658 const Decl *Container) const {
5659 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005660 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005661 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
5662 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00005663 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
5664 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5665 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005666 } else {
5667 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
5668 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
5669 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5670 return PID;
5671 }
5672 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005673}
5674
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005675/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005676/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005677/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
5678/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005679/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
5680/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
5681/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
5682/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
5683/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005684/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
5685/// @code
5686/// enum PropertyAttributes {
5687/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
5688/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5689/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5690/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
5691/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
5692/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
5693/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00005694/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005695/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5696/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5697/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5698/// };
5699/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005700void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005701 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005702 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005703 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5704 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005705 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005706
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005707 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5708 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5709 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5710 Dynamic = true;
5711 else
5712 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005713 }
5714
5715 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5716 S = "T";
5717
5718 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005719 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5720 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005721 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005722
5723 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5724 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005725 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5726 S += ",C";
5727 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5728 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00005729 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5730 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005731 } else {
5732 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5733 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5734 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005735 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005736 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005737 }
5738 }
5739
5740 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5741 // are "dynamic by default".
5742 if (Dynamic)
5743 S += ",D";
5744
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005745 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5746 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005747
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005748 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5749 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005750 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005751 }
5752
5753 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5754 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005755 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005756 }
5757
5758 if (SynthesizePID) {
5759 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5760 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005761 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005762 }
5763
5764 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5765}
5766
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005767/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005768/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5769/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005770/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5771///
5772void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005773 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005774 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005775 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005776 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005777 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005778 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005779 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5780 }
5781 }
5782}
5783
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005784void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005785 const FieldDecl *Field,
5786 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005787 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5788 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5789 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5790 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005791 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005792 true /* outermost type */, false, false,
5793 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005794}
5795
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005796void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5797 std::string& S) const {
5798 // Encode result type.
5799 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5800 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5801 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5802 true /* outermost type */,
5803 true /* encoding property */);
5804}
5805
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005806static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5807 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5808 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005809 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5810 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5811 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5812 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005813 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005814 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005815 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005816 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5817 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005818 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005819 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5820 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5821 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5822 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5823 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005824 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5825 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005826 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5827 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005828 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005829 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5830 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5831 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5832 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005833 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005834 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5835
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005836 case BuiltinType::Float128:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005837 case BuiltinType::Half:
5838 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5839 return ' ';
5840
5841 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5842 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5843 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5844 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5845
5846 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00005847#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
5848 case BuiltinType::Id:
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00005849#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005850 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00005851 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
5852 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
5853 case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange:
5854 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005855 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005856 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5857#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5858#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5859 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5860#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5861 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005862 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005863 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005864}
5865
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005866static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5867 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5868
5869 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5870 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5871 return 'i';
5872
5873 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005874 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5875 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005876}
5877
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005878static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005879 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005880 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005881 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005882 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5883 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5884 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5885 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5886 //
5887 // struct
5888 // {
5889 // int integer;
5890 // int flags:2;
5891 // };
5892 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5893 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5894 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5895 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5896 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005897 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005898 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5899 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005900 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005901 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5902 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005903 else {
5904 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5905 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5906 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005907 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005908 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005909}
5910
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005911// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005912void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5913 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5914 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005915 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005916 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005917 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005918 bool StructField,
5919 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005920 bool EncodeClassNames,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005921 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5922 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005923 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5924 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5925 case Type::Builtin:
5926 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005927 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005928 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005929 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5930 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5931 else
5932 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005933 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005934
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005935 case Type::Complex: {
5936 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005937 S += 'j';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005938 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005939 return;
5940 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005941
5942 case Type::Atomic: {
5943 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5944 S += 'A';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005945 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005946 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005947 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005948
5949 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5950 case Type::Pointer:
5951 case Type::LValueReference:
5952 case Type::RValueReference: {
5953 QualType PointeeTy;
5954 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5955 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5956 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5957 S += ':';
5958 return;
5959 }
5960 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5961 } else {
5962 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5963 }
5964
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005965 bool isReadOnly = false;
5966 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5967 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5968 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005969 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005970 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005971 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5972 isReadOnly = true;
5973 S += 'r';
5974 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005975 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005976 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005977 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5978 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005979 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5980 isReadOnly = true;
5981 S += 'r';
5982 }
5983 }
5984 if (isReadOnly) {
5985 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5986 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5987 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005988 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005989 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005990 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005991
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005992 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5993 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5994 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005995 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005996 S += '*';
5997 return;
5998 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005999 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00006000 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
6001 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
6002 S += '#';
6003 return;
6004 }
6005 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
6006 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
6007 S += '@';
6008 return;
6009 }
6010 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006011 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006012 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006013 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
6014
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006015 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006016 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
6017 NotEncodedT);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006018 return;
6019 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006020
6021 case Type::ConstantArray:
6022 case Type::IncompleteArray:
6023 case Type::VariableArray: {
6024 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
6025
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006026 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006027 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
6028 S += '^';
6029
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006030 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006031 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
6032 } else {
6033 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006034
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00006035 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
6036 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
6037 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006038 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006039 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
6040 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006041 S += '0';
6042 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006043
6044 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006045 false, ExpandStructures, FD,
6046 false, false, false, false, false, false,
6047 NotEncodedT);
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006048 S += ']';
6049 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006050 return;
6051 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006052
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006053 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
6054 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00006055 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006056 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006057
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006058 case Type::Record: {
6059 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006060 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00006061 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
6062 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
6063 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00006064 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
6065 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
6066 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00006067 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
6068 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00006069 TemplateArgs.asArray(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00006070 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00006071 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00006072 } else {
6073 S += '?';
6074 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00006075 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006076 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006077 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006078 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006079 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006080 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006081 if (FD) {
6082 S += '"';
6083 S += Field->getNameAsString();
6084 S += '"';
6085 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006086
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006087 // Special case bit-fields.
6088 if (Field->isBitField()) {
6089 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006090 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006091 } else {
6092 QualType qt = Field->getType();
6093 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6094 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
6095 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
6096 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006097 /*StructField*/true,
6098 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006099 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006100 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006101 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00006102 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006103 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006104 return;
6105 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006106
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006107 case Type::BlockPointer: {
6108 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00006109 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006110 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006111 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006112
6113 S += '<';
6114 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006115 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
6116 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
6117 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006118 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
6119 NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006120 // Block self
6121 S += "@?";
6122 // Block parameters
6123 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00006124 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
6125 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
6126 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
6127 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006128 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
6129 false, NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006130 }
6131 S += '>';
6132 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006133 return;
6134 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006135
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00006136 case Type::ObjCObject: {
6137 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
6138 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
6139 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
6140 S += "{objc_object=}";
6141 return;
6142 }
6143 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
6144 S += "{objc_class=}";
6145 return;
6146 }
6147 }
6148
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006149 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
6150 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006151 // @encode(class_name)
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006152 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006153 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006154 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Akira Hatanakafd0fb202016-08-17 19:42:22 +00006155 if (ExpandStructures) {
6156 S += '=';
6157 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
6158 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
6159 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
6160 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
6161 if (Field->isBitField())
6162 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
6163 else
6164 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
6165 false, false, false, false, false,
6166 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
6167 NotEncodedT);
6168 }
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006169 }
6170 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006171 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006172 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006173
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006174 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
6175 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006176 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
6177 S += '@';
6178 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006179 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006180
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00006181 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
6182 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
6183 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
6184 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006185 S += '#';
6186 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006187 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006188
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006189 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006190 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006191 ExpandPointedToStructures,
6192 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006193 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006194 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
6195 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006196 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006197 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006198 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006199 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006200 S += '>';
6201 }
6202 S += '"';
6203 }
6204 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006205 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006206
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006207 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
6208 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006209 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
6210 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006211 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006212 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006213 // {...};
6214 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006215 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00006216 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006217 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
6218 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
6219 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
6220 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
6221 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
6222 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006223 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006224 S += '}';
6225 return;
6226 }
6227 }
6228 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006229 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
6230 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006231 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006232 false, false, false, false, false,
6233 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006234 return;
6235 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006236
6237 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006238 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
6239 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006240 S += '"';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006241 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006242 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006243 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006244 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006245 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006246 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006247 S += '"';
6248 }
6249 return;
6250 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006251
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00006252 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006253 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
6254 case Type::MemberPointer:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006255 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
6256 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006257 case Type::Vector:
6258 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006259 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
6260 { if (NotEncodedT)
6261 *NotEncodedT = T;
6262 return;
6263 }
6264
6265 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
6266 // Just ignore it.
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00006267 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00006268 return;
6269
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00006270 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006271#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
6272#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
6273#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6274 case Type::KIND:
6275#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6276 case Type::KIND:
6277#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6278 case Type::KIND:
6279#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
6280 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00006281 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006282 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006283}
6284
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006285void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
6286 std::string &S,
6287 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006288 bool includeVBases,
6289 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006290 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
6291 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
Argyrios Kyrtzidis785705b2016-01-16 00:20:02 +00006292 if (!RDecl->getDefinition() || RDecl->getDefinition()->isInvalidDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006293 return;
6294
6295 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
6296 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
6297 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
6298
6299 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00006300 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
6301 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
6302 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006303 if (base->isEmpty())
6304 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00006305 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006306 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
6307 std::make_pair(offs, base));
6308 }
6309 }
6310 }
6311
6312 unsigned i = 0;
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00006313 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006314 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
6315 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00006316 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
6317 ++i;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006318 }
6319
6320 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00006321 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
6322 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006323 if (base->isEmpty())
6324 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00006325 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00006326 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
6327 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00006328 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
6329 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006330 }
6331 }
6332
6333 CharUnits size;
6334 if (CXXRec) {
6335 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
6336 } else {
6337 size = layout.getSize();
6338 }
6339
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006340#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006341 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006342#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006343 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
6344 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
6345
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00006346 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
6347 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006348 if (FD) {
6349 S += "\"_vptr$";
6350 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
6351 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
6352 S += recname;
6353 S += '"';
6354 }
6355 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006356#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006357 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006358#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006359 }
6360
6361 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
6362 // Mark the end of the structure.
6363 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
6364 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006365 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006366 }
6367
6368 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006369#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006370 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006371 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
6372 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
6373 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
6374 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
6375 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
6376 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
6377 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
6378 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
6379 // longer then though.
6380 CurOffs += padding;
6381 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006382#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006383
6384 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006385 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006386 break; // reached end of structure.
6387
6388 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
6389 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
6390 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
6391 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
6392 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006393 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
6394 NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006395 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006396#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006397 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006398#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006399 } else {
6400 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
6401 if (FD) {
6402 S += '"';
6403 S += field->getNameAsString();
6404 S += '"';
6405 }
6406
6407 if (field->isBitField()) {
6408 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006409#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006410 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006411#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006412 } else {
6413 QualType qt = field->getType();
6414 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6415 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
6416 /*OutermostType*/false,
6417 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006418 /*StructField*/true,
6419 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006420#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006421 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006422#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006423 }
6424 }
6425 }
6426}
6427
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006428void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00006429 std::string& S) const {
6430 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
6431 S += 'n';
6432 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
6433 S += 'N';
6434 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
6435 S += 'o';
6436 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
6437 S += 'O';
6438 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
6439 S += 'R';
6440 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
6441 S += 'V';
6442}
6443
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006444TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
6445 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00006446 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, { }, { });
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006447 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006448 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006449 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006450 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00006451}
6452
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006453TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
6454 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006455 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
6456 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006457 }
6458 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00006459}
6460
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006461TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
6462 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00006463 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, { }, { });
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006464 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006465 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006466 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006467 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00006468}
6469
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006470ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
6471 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
6472 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
6473 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6474 SourceLocation(),
6475 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Douglas Gregor85f3f952015-07-07 03:57:15 +00006476 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006477 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006478 SourceLocation(), true);
6479 }
6480
6481 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
6482}
6483
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006484//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6485// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
6486//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6487
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006488static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6489 StringRef Name) {
6490 // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006491 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006492 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name);
6493}
6494
6495static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6496 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list");
6497}
6498
6499static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6500 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006501}
6502
6503static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6504 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006505 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6506 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006507}
6508
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006509static TypedefDecl *
6510CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006511 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006512 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006513 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6514 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6515 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6516 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6517 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006518 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006519 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006520 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006521 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006522 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006523 }
6524
6525 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6526
6527 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6528 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6529 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6530
6531 // void *__stack;
6532 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6533 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
6534
6535 // void *__gr_top;
6536 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6537 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
6538
6539 // void *__vr_top;
6540 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6541 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
6542
6543 // int __gr_offs;
6544 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
6545 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
6546
6547 // int __vr_offs;
6548 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
6549 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
6550
6551 // Create fields
6552 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6553 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6554 VaListTagDecl,
6555 SourceLocation(),
6556 SourceLocation(),
6557 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006558 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6559 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006560 /*Mutable=*/false,
6561 ICIS_NoInit);
6562 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6563 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6564 }
6565 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006566 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006567 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006568
6569 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006570 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006571}
6572
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006573static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6574 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6575 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6576
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006577 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006578 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6579
6580 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6581 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6582 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6583
6584 // unsigned char gpr;
6585 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6586 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
6587
6588 // unsigned char fpr;
6589 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6590 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
6591
6592 // unsigned short reserved;
6593 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
6594 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
6595
6596 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6597 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6598 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
6599
6600 // void* reg_save_area;
6601 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6602 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
6603
6604 // Create fields
6605 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6606 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
6607 SourceLocation(),
6608 SourceLocation(),
6609 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006610 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6611 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006612 /*Mutable=*/false,
6613 ICIS_NoInit);
6614 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6615 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6616 }
6617 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006618 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006619 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6620
6621 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006622 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6623 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6624
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006625 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6626 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6627
6628 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6629 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6630 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6631 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6632 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006633 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006634}
6635
6636static TypedefDecl *
6637CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006638 // struct __va_list_tag {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006639 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006640 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006641 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6642
6643 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6644 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6645 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6646
6647 // unsigned gp_offset;
6648 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6649 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
6650
6651 // unsigned fp_offset;
6652 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6653 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
6654
6655 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6656 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6657 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
6658
6659 // void* reg_save_area;
6660 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6661 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
6662
6663 // Create fields
6664 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6665 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6666 VaListTagDecl,
6667 SourceLocation(),
6668 SourceLocation(),
6669 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006670 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6671 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006672 /*Mutable=*/false,
6673 ICIS_NoInit);
6674 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6675 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6676 }
6677 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006678 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006679 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6680
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006681 // };
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006682
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006683 // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006684 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006685 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6686 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006687 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006688}
6689
6690static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6691 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
6692 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
Yaron Kerene0bcdd42016-10-08 06:45:10 +00006693 QualType IntArrayType =
6694 Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006695 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006696}
6697
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006698static TypedefDecl *
6699CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006700 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006701 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006702 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6703 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6704 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6705 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6706 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6707 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6708 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006709 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006710 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006711 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006712 }
6713
6714 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6715
6716 // void * __ap;
6717 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6718 VaListDecl,
6719 SourceLocation(),
6720 SourceLocation(),
6721 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6722 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006723 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6724 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006725 /*Mutable=*/false,
6726 ICIS_NoInit);
6727 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6728 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6729
6730 // };
6731 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
Oleg Ranevskyyb88d2472016-03-30 21:30:30 +00006732 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListDecl;
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006733
6734 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006735 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6736 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006737}
6738
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006739static TypedefDecl *
6740CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006741 // struct __va_list_tag {
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006742 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006743 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006744 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6745
6746 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6747 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6748 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6749
6750 // long __gpr;
6751 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6752 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6753
6754 // long __fpr;
6755 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6756 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6757
6758 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6759 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6760 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6761
6762 // void *__reg_save_area;
6763 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6764 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6765
6766 // Create fields
6767 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6768 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6769 VaListTagDecl,
6770 SourceLocation(),
6771 SourceLocation(),
6772 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006773 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6774 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006775 /*Mutable=*/false,
6776 ICIS_NoInit);
6777 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6778 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6779 }
6780 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006781 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006782 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006783
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006784 // };
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006785
6786 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6787 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006788 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6789 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006790
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006791 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006792}
6793
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006794static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6795 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6796 switch (Kind) {
6797 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6798 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6799 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6800 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006801 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6802 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006803 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6804 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6805 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6806 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6807 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6808 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006809 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6810 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006811 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6812 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006813 }
6814
6815 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6816}
6817
6818TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006819 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006820 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006821 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6822 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006823
6824 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6825}
6826
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006827Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const {
6828 // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006829 // declaration.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006830 if (!VaListTagDecl)
6831 (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl();
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006832
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006833 return VaListTagDecl;
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006834}
6835
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006836TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const {
6837 if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl)
6838 BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this);
6839
6840 return BuiltinMSVaListDecl;
6841}
6842
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006843void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006844 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006845 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006846
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006847 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006848}
6849
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006850/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6851/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006852TemplateName
6853ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6854 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006855 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6856 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6857
6858 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6859 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6860 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6861
6862 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006863 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006864 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6865 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6866 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6867 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6868 *Storage++ = D;
6869 }
6870
6871 return TemplateName(OT);
6872}
6873
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006874/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6875/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006876TemplateName
6877ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6878 bool TemplateKeyword,
6879 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006880 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6881
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006882 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006883 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6884 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6885
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006886 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006887 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6888 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6889 if (!QTN) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00006890 QTN = new (*this, alignof(QualifiedTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006891 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006892 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6893 }
6894
6895 return TemplateName(QTN);
6896}
6897
6898/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6899/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006900TemplateName
6901ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6902 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006903 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006904 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006905
6906 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6907 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6908
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006909 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006910 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6911 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6912
6913 if (QTN)
6914 return TemplateName(QTN);
6915
6916 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6917 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00006918 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006919 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006920 } else {
6921 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00006922 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006923 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006924 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6925 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6926 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6927 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006928 }
6929
6930 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6931 return TemplateName(QTN);
6932}
6933
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006934/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6935/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6936TemplateName
6937ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006938 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006939 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6940 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6941
6942 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6943 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006944
6945 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006946 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6947 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006948
6949 if (QTN)
6950 return TemplateName(QTN);
6951
6952 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6953 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00006954 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006955 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006956 } else {
6957 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00006958 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006959 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00006960
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006961 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6962 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6963 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6964 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006965 }
6966
6967 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6968 return TemplateName(QTN);
6969}
6970
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006971TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006972ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6973 TemplateName replacement) const {
6974 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6975 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006976
6977 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006978 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6979 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6980
6981 if (!subst) {
6982 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6983 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6984 }
6985
6986 return TemplateName(subst);
6987}
6988
6989TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006990ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6991 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6992 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6993 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6994 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006995
6996 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006997 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6998 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6999
7000 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007001 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007002 ArgPack.pack_size(),
7003 ArgPack.pack_begin());
7004 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
7005 }
7006
7007 return TemplateName(Subst);
7008}
7009
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007010/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00007011/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
7012/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00007013CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007014 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00007015 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00007016 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
7017 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007018 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
7019 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
7020 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
7021 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
7022 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
7023 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
7024 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
7025 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
7026 }
7027
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007028 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007029}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00007030
7031//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7032// Type Predicates.
7033//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7034
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007035/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
7036/// garbage collection attribute.
7037///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007038Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007039 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007040 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
7041
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007042 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007043 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
7044
7045 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
7046 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
7047 // as __strong.
7048 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
7049 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
7050 return Qualifiers::Strong;
7051 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
7052 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
7053 } else {
7054 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
7055 // pointer.
7056#ifndef NDEBUG
7057 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
7058 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
7059 CT = AT->getElementType();
7060 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
7061#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007062 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00007063 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007064}
7065
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007066//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7067// Type Compatibility Testing
7068//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00007069
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007070/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007071/// compatible.
7072static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
7073 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00007074 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007075 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007076 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007077}
7078
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007079bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
7080 QualType SecondVec) {
7081 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
7082 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
7083
7084 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
7085 return true;
7086
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007087 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
7088 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007089 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
7090 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007091 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007092 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007093 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
7094 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
7095 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
7096 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007097 return true;
7098
7099 return false;
7100}
7101
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007102//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7103// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
7104//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7105
7106/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
7107/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007108bool
7109ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
7110 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00007111 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007112 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00007113 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
7114 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007115 return true;
7116 return false;
7117}
7118
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00007119/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
7120/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007121bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
7122 QualType rhs) {
7123 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7124 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7125 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
7126
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007127 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007128 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007129 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007130 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
7131 match = true;
7132 break;
7133 }
7134 }
7135 if (!match)
7136 return false;
7137 }
7138 return true;
7139}
7140
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007141/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
7142/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
7143bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7144 bool compare) {
7145 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007146 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007147 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
7148 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007149 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007150 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
7151 return true;
7152
7153 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007154 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007155
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007156 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007157
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007158 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007159 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007160 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
7161 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007162 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007163 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7164 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7165 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007166 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007167 return false;
7168 }
7169 }
7170 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
7171 return true;
7172 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007173 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007174 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007175 bool match = false;
7176
7177 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7178 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7179 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007180 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007181 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7182 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7183 match = true;
7184 break;
7185 }
7186 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007187 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007188 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
7189 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007190 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007191 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7192 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7193 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007194 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007195 match = true;
7196 break;
7197 }
7198 }
7199 }
7200 if (!match)
7201 return false;
7202 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007203
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007204 return true;
7205 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007206
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007207 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
7208 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
7209
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007210 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007211 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007212 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007213 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007214 bool match = false;
7215
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007216 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007217 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7218 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007219 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
7220 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007221 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007222 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7223 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7224 match = true;
7225 break;
7226 }
7227 }
7228 if (!match)
7229 return false;
7230 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007231
7232 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
7233 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
7234 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
7235 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
7236 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
7237 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
7238 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
7239 // assume that it is mismatch.
7240 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
7241 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007242 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007243 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007244 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007245 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7246 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7247 match = true;
7248 break;
7249 }
7250 }
7251 if (!match)
7252 return false;
7253 }
7254 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007255 return true;
7256 }
7257 return false;
7258}
7259
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007260/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007261/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
7262/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
7263///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007264bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7265 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007266 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7267 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7268
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00007269 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007270 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
7271 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007272 return true;
7273
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007274 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
7275 // __kindof types.
7276 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
7277 if (succeeded)
7278 return true;
7279
7280 if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
7281 return false;
7282
7283 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
7284 // we can assign the other way.
7285 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7286 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
7287 };
7288
7289 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
7290 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7291 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7292 false));
7293 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007294
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007295 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
7296 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7297 QualType(RHSOPT,0)));
7298 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007299
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007300 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007301 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
7302 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
7303 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007304
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007305 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007306}
7307
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007308/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00007309/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007310/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
7311/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
7312/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
7313bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7314 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007315 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
7316 bool BlockReturnType) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007317
7318 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
7319 // __kindof types.
7320 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
7321 if (succeeded)
7322 return true;
7323
7324 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
7325 if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
7326 return false;
7327
7328 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
7329 // we can assign the other way.
7330 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7331 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7332 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7333 BlockReturnType);
7334 };
7335
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007336 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007337 return true;
7338
7339 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007340 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
7341 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007342 }
7343
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007344 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007345 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7346 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7347 false));
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007348
7349 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7350 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7351 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
7352 if (LHS != RHS) {
7353 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007354 return finish(BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007355 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007356 return finish(!BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007357 }
7358 else
7359 return true;
7360 }
7361 return false;
7362}
7363
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007364/// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
7365/// llvm::array_pod_sort.
7366static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
7367 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
7368 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
7369
7370}
7371
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007372/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007373/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
7374/// the given common base.
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007375/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
7376/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
7377static
7378void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007379 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007380 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7381 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007382 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007383
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007384 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7385 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7386 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
7387 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007388
7389 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
7390 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
7391
7392 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7393 for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) {
7394 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007395 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007396
7397 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
7398 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
7399
7400 // Add all of the protocls for the RHS.
7401 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
7402
7403 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7404 for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) {
7405 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007406 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007407
7408 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
7409 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
7410
7411 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
7412 for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
7413 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
7414 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
7415 }
7416
7417 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
7418 // the protocols within the intersection.
7419 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
7420 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
7421
7422 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
7423 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
7424 IntersectionSet.erase(
7425 std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(),
7426 IntersectionSet.end(),
7427 [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
7428 return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0;
7429 }),
7430 IntersectionSet.end());
7431 }
7432
7433 // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
7434 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
7435 compareObjCProtocolsByName);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007436}
7437
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007438/// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
7439static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
7440 QualType rhs) {
7441 // Common case: two object pointers.
7442 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7443 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7444 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
7445 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
7446
7447 // Two block pointers.
7448 const BlockPointerType *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7449 const BlockPointerType *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7450 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
7451 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
7452
7453 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
7454 // acceptable.
7455 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
7456 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
7457 return true;
7458
7459 return false;
7460}
7461
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007462// Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007463static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
7464 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
7465 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007466 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
7467 bool stripKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007468 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
7469 return false;
7470
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007471 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007472 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007473 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7474 continue;
7475
7476 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
7477 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007478 if (!stripKindOf ||
7479 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
7480 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
7481 return false;
7482 }
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007483 break;
7484
7485 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
7486 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7487 return false;
7488 break;
7489
7490 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
7491 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
7492 return false;
7493 break;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007494 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007495 }
7496
7497 return true;
7498}
7499
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007500QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007501 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
7502 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007503 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
7504 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
7505 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
7506 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007507
7508 if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007509 return QualType();
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007510
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007511 // When either LHS or RHS is a kindof type, we should return a kindof type.
7512 // For example, for common base of kindof(ASub1) and kindof(ASub2), we return
7513 // kindof(A).
7514 bool anyKindOf = LHS->isKindOfType() || RHS->isKindOfType();
7515
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007516 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
7517 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
7518 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
7519 LHSAncestors;
7520 while (true) {
7521 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
7522 // path from the LHS to the root.
7523 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007524
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007525 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
7526 // Get the type arguments.
7527 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7528 bool anyChanges = false;
7529 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7530 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007531 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7532 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007533 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007534 return QualType();
7535 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7536 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7537 // arguments.
7538 LHSTypeArgs = { };
7539 anyChanges = true;
7540 }
7541
7542 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007543 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007544 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7545 Protocols);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007546 if (!Protocols.empty())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007547 anyChanges = true;
7548
7549 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007550 // If we need to return a kindof type but LHS is not a kindof type, we
7551 // build a new result type.
7552 if (anyChanges || LHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007553 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007554 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007555 anyKindOf || LHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007556 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7557 }
7558
7559 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007560 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007561
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007562 // Find the superclass.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007563 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
7564 if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
7565 break;
7566
7567 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7568 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007569
7570 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
7571 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
7572 while (true) {
7573 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
7574 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
7575 LHS = KnownLHS->second;
7576
7577 // Get the type arguments.
7578 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7579 bool anyChanges = false;
7580 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7581 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007582 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7583 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007584 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007585 return QualType();
7586 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7587 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7588 // arguments.
7589 RHSTypeArgs = { };
7590 anyChanges = true;
7591 }
7592
7593 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
7594 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
7595 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7596 Protocols);
7597 if (!Protocols.empty())
7598 anyChanges = true;
7599
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007600 // If we need to return a kindof type but RHS is not a kindof type, we
7601 // build a new result type.
7602 if (anyChanges || RHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007603 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007604 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007605 anyKindOf || RHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007606 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7607 }
7608
7609 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
7610 }
7611
7612 // Find the superclass of the RHS.
7613 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
7614 if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
7615 break;
7616
7617 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7618 }
7619
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007620 return QualType();
7621}
7622
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007623bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
7624 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
7625 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
7626 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
7627
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007628 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
7629 // the LHS.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007630 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
7631 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
7632 if (!IsSuperClass)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007633 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007634
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007635 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
7636 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
7637 // LHS).
7638 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007639 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
7640 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
7641 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
7642 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
7643 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
7644 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
7645 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
7646 // qualifiers.
7647 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007648 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007649 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
7650 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00007651 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007652
7653 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
7654 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
7655 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
7656 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
7657 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
7658 break;
7659 }
7660 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
7661 return false;
7662 }
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007663 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007664
7665 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
7666 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
7667 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
7668 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
7669 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
7670 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
7671 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7672
7673 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007674 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007675 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7676 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007677 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007678 return false;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007679 }
7680 }
7681
7682 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007683}
7684
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007685bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7686 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007687 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7688 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007689
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007690 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007691 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007692
7693 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
7694 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007695}
7696
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00007697bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
7698 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
7699 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7700 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
7701}
7702
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007703/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007704/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007705/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007706/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007707bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
7708 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007709 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007710 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
7711
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007712 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007713}
7714
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00007715bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00007716 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00007717}
7718
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007719bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7720 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
7721}
7722
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007723/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
7724/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
7725/// QualType()
7726QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
7727 bool OfBlockPointer,
7728 bool Unqualified) {
7729 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
7730 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
7731 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00007732 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
7733 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007734 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7735 if (!MT.isNull())
7736 return MT;
7737 }
7738 }
7739 }
7740
7741 return QualType();
7742}
7743
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007744/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
7745/// parameter types
7746QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7747 bool OfBlockPointer,
7748 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007749 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
7750 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
7751 // type is compatible with a union member
7752 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
7753 Unqualified);
7754 if (!lmerge.isNull())
7755 return lmerge;
7756
7757 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
7758 Unqualified);
7759 if (!rmerge.isNull())
7760 return rmerge;
7761
7762 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7763}
7764
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007765QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007766 bool OfBlockPointer,
7767 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007768 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
7769 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007770 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
7771 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007772 bool allLTypes = true;
7773 bool allRTypes = true;
7774
7775 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007776 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007777 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007778 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
7779 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007780 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
7781 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
7782 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007783 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007784 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007785 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007786 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007787 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007788 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007789
7790 if (Unqualified)
7791 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
7792
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007793 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
7794 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007795 if (Unqualified) {
7796 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7797 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7798 }
7799
7800 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007801 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007802 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007803 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007804
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00007805 // FIXME: double check this
7806 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7807 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7808 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00007809 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
7810 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007811
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007812 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007813 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007814 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007815
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007816 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00007817 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
7818 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007819 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
7820 return QualType();
7821
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007822 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
7823 return QualType();
7824
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007825 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
7826 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007827
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00007828 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7829 allLTypes = false;
7830 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7831 allRTypes = false;
7832
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007833 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007834
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007835 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007836 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
7837 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007838 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
7839 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007840 return QualType();
7841
7842 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
7843 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
7844 return QualType();
7845
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00007846 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
7847 return QualType();
7848
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00007849 if (!doFunctionTypesMatchOnExtParameterInfos(rproto, lproto))
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007850 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007851
7852 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007853 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007854 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
7855 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7856 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7857 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
7858 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7859 if (paramType.isNull())
7860 return QualType();
7861
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007862 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007863 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
7864
7865 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007866 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007867 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7868 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007869 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007870
7871 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007872 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007873 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007874 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007875 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007876
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007877 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7878 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007879
7880 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7881 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007882 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007883 }
7884
7885 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7886 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7887
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007888 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007889 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007890 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007891 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7892 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7893 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7894 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7895 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7896 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007897 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
7898 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007899
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007900 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007901 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007902 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7903 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7904 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007905 return QualType();
7906 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007907
7908 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7909 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007910 return QualType();
7911 }
7912
7913 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7914 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007915
7916 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7917 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007918 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007919 }
7920
7921 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7922 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007923 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007924}
7925
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007926/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7927static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7928 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7929 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7930 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7931 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7932 // type.
7933 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7934 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7935 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7936 return other;
7937
7938 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7939 // integral type of the same size.
7940 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7941 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7942 return other;
7943
7944 return QualType();
7945}
7946
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007947QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007948 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007949 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007950 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7951 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7952 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007953 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7954 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007955 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7956 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007957
7958 if (Unqualified) {
7959 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7960 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7961 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007962
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007963 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7964 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7965
7966 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7967 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7968 return LHS;
7969
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007970 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007971 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7972 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007973 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
Yaxun Liua1a87ad2016-04-12 19:43:36 +00007974 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
Yaxun Liuab933942016-04-28 17:34:57 +00007975 if (LHSCan.getUnqualifiedType() != RHSCan.getUnqualifiedType() ||
Yaxun Liua1a87ad2016-04-12 19:43:36 +00007976 LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers())
7977 return QualType();
7978 if (LQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(RQuals))
7979 return LHS;
7980 if (RQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(LQuals))
7981 return RHS;
7982 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007983 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7984 // mismatch.
7985 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007986 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7987 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007988 return QualType();
7989
7990 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7991 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7992 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7993 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7994 // qualified __strong.
7995 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7996 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7997 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7998
7999 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
8000 return QualType();
8001
8002 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8003 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
8004 }
8005 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8006 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
8007 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008008 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008009 }
8010
8011 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008012
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00008013 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
8014 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008015
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008016 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
8017 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
8018 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
8019 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00008020
8021 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00008022 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
8023 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
8024 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
8025 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008026
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008027 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
8028 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
8029 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
8030
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00008031 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
8032 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
8033 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008034
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00008035 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008036 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008037 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
8038 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008039 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008040 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00008041 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008042 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008043 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00008044 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00008045 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00008046 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
8047 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
8048 return LHS;
8049 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
8050 return RHS;
8051 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00008052
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008053 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008054 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008055
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00008056 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008057 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008058#define TYPE(Class, Base)
8059#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00008060#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008061#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
8062#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
8063#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008064 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008065
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00008066 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00008067 case Type::LValueReference:
8068 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008069 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008070 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008071
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008072 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008073 case Type::IncompleteArray:
8074 case Type::VariableArray:
8075 case Type::FunctionProto:
8076 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008077 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008078
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008079 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008080 {
8081 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008082 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8083 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008084 if (Unqualified) {
8085 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8086 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8087 }
8088 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
8089 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008090 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00008091 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008092 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00008093 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008094 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008095 return getPointerType(ResultType);
8096 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00008097 case Type::BlockPointer:
8098 {
8099 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008100 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8101 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008102 if (Unqualified) {
8103 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8104 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8105 }
8106 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
8107 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00008108 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
8109 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8110 return LHS;
8111 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8112 return RHS;
8113 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
8114 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00008115 case Type::Atomic:
8116 {
8117 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
8118 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
8119 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
8120 if (Unqualified) {
8121 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8122 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8123 }
8124 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
8125 Unqualified);
8126 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
8127 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8128 return LHS;
8129 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8130 return RHS;
8131 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
8132 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008133 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008134 {
8135 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
8136 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
8137 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
8138 return QualType();
8139
8140 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
8141 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008142 if (Unqualified) {
8143 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
8144 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
8145 }
8146
8147 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008148 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008149 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8150 return LHS;
8151 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8152 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00008153 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
8154 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
8155 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
8156 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008157 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
8158 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008159 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8160 return LHS;
8161 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8162 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008163 if (LVAT) {
8164 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
8165 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
8166 // has to be different.
8167 return LHS;
8168 }
8169 if (RVAT) {
8170 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
8171 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
8172 // has to be different.
8173 return RHS;
8174 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00008175 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
8176 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00008177 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
8178 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008179 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008180 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008181 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008182 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008183 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008184 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008185 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00008186 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008187 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00008188 case Type::Complex:
8189 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
8190 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00008191 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00008192 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00008193 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
8194 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008195 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008196 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008197 case Type::ObjCObject: {
8198 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00008199 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
8200 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008201 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8202 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8203 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00008204 return LHS;
8205
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008206 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00008207 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008208 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008209 if (OfBlockPointer) {
8210 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
8211 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008212 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8213 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008214 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008215 return QualType();
8216 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008217 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8218 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008219 return LHS;
8220
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00008221 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008222 }
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00008223 case Type::Pipe:
8224 {
8225 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
8226 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<PipeType>()->getElementType();
8227 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<PipeType>()->getElementType();
8228 if (Unqualified) {
8229 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8230 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8231 }
8232 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
8233 Unqualified);
8234 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
8235 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8236 return LHS;
8237 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8238 return RHS;
8239 return getPipeType(ResultType);
8240 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008241 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008242
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008243 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008244}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00008245
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008246bool ASTContext::doFunctionTypesMatchOnExtParameterInfos(
8247 const FunctionProtoType *firstFnType,
8248 const FunctionProtoType *secondFnType) {
8249 // Fast path: if the first type doesn't have ext parameter infos,
8250 // we match if and only if they second type also doesn't have them.
8251 if (!firstFnType->hasExtParameterInfos())
8252 return !secondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
8253
8254 // Otherwise, we can only match if the second type has them.
8255 if (!secondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008256 return false;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008257
8258 auto firstEPI = firstFnType->getExtParameterInfos();
8259 auto secondEPI = secondFnType->getExtParameterInfos();
8260 assert(firstEPI.size() == secondEPI.size());
8261
8262 for (size_t i = 0, n = firstEPI.size(); i != n; ++i) {
8263 if (firstEPI[i] != secondEPI[i])
8264 return false;
8265 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008266 return true;
8267}
8268
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00008269void ASTContext::ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl *CD) {
8270 ObjCLayouts[CD] = nullptr;
8271}
8272
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008273/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
8274/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
8275/// return types.
8276QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
8277 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
8278 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
8279 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
8280 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
8281 return LHS;
8282 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
8283 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
8284 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008285 QualType OldReturnType =
8286 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008287 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008288 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008289 QualType ResReturnType =
8290 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
8291 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
8292 return QualType();
8293 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
8294 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
8295 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
8296 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
8297 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008298 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
8299 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00008300 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008301 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008302 return ResultType;
8303 }
8304 }
8305 return QualType();
8306 }
8307
8308 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
8309 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8310 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8311 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
8312 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
8313 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
8314 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
8315 return QualType();
8316
8317 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
8318 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
8319 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
8320 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
8321 // qualified __strong.
8322 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8323 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8324 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
8325
8326 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
8327 return QualType();
8328
8329 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
8330 return LHS;
8331 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
8332 return RHS;
8333 return QualType();
8334 }
8335
8336 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8337 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8338 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8339 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
8340 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
8341 return LHS;
8342 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
8343 return RHS;
8344 }
8345 return QualType();
8346}
8347
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00008348//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008349// Integer Predicates
8350//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00008351
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008352unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00008353 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00008354 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00008355 if (T->isBooleanType())
8356 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00008357 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008358 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
8359}
8360
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00008361QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00008362 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008363
8364 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
8365 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
8366 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008367 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008368
8369 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
8370 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008371 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008372
8373 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8374 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008375 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
8376 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
8377 case BuiltinType::SChar:
8378 return UnsignedCharTy;
8379 case BuiltinType::Short:
8380 return UnsignedShortTy;
8381 case BuiltinType::Int:
8382 return UnsignedIntTy;
8383 case BuiltinType::Long:
8384 return UnsignedLongTy;
8385 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
8386 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00008387 case BuiltinType::Int128:
8388 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008389 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008390 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008391 }
8392}
8393
Angel Garcia Gomez637d1e62015-10-20 13:23:58 +00008394ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00008395
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00008396void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
8397 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008398
8399//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8400// Builtin Type Computation
8401//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8402
8403/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008404/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
8405/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
8406/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
8407/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008408///
8409/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
8410/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008411static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008412 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008413 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008414 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008415 // Modifiers.
8416 int HowLong = 0;
8417 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008418 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008419
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008420 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008421 bool Done = false;
8422 while (!Done) {
8423 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008424 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008425 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008426 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008427 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008428 case 'S':
8429 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
8430 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
8431 Signed = true;
8432 break;
8433 case 'U':
8434 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008435 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008436 Unsigned = true;
8437 break;
8438 case 'L':
8439 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
8440 ++HowLong;
8441 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008442 case 'W':
8443 // This modifier represents int64 type.
8444 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
8445 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
8446 default:
8447 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
8448 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
8449 HowLong = 1;
8450 break;
8451 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
8452 HowLong = 2;
8453 break;
8454 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008455 }
8456 }
8457
8458 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008459
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008460 // Read the base type.
8461 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008462 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008463 case 'v':
8464 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8465 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
8466 Type = Context.VoidTy;
8467 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008468 case 'h':
8469 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008470 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008471 Type = Context.HalfTy;
8472 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008473 case 'f':
8474 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8475 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
8476 Type = Context.FloatTy;
8477 break;
8478 case 'd':
8479 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8480 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
8481 if (HowLong)
8482 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
8483 else
8484 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
8485 break;
8486 case 's':
8487 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
8488 if (Unsigned)
8489 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
8490 else
8491 Type = Context.ShortTy;
8492 break;
8493 case 'i':
8494 if (HowLong == 3)
8495 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
8496 else if (HowLong == 2)
8497 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
8498 else if (HowLong == 1)
8499 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
8500 else
8501 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
8502 break;
8503 case 'c':
8504 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
8505 if (Signed)
8506 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
8507 else if (Unsigned)
8508 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
8509 else
8510 Type = Context.CharTy;
8511 break;
8512 case 'b': // boolean
8513 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
8514 Type = Context.BoolTy;
8515 break;
8516 case 'z': // size_t.
8517 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
8518 Type = Context.getSizeType();
8519 break;
8520 case 'F':
8521 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
8522 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00008523 case 'G':
8524 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
8525 break;
8526 case 'H':
8527 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
8528 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00008529 case 'M':
8530 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
8531 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008532 case 'a':
8533 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8534 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
8535 break;
8536 case 'A':
8537 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
8538 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
8539 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
8540 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
8541 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
8542 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
8543 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
8544 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
8545 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8546 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008547 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008548 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008549 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008550 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008551 break;
8552 case 'V': {
8553 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008554 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8555 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008556 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008557
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008558 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
8559 RequiresICE, false);
8560 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008561
8562 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00008563 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008564 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008565 break;
8566 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00008567 case 'E': {
8568 char *End;
8569
8570 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8571 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
8572
8573 Str = End;
8574
8575 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8576 false);
8577 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
8578 break;
8579 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00008580 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008581 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8582 false);
8583 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00008584 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
8585 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00008586 }
8587 case 'Y' : {
8588 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
8589 break;
8590 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00008591 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00008592 Type = Context.getFILEType();
8593 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008594 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008595 return QualType();
8596 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008597 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00008598 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008599 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00008600 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008601 else
8602 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
8603
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008604 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008605 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008606 return QualType();
8607 }
8608 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00008609 case 'K':
8610 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
8611 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
8612
8613 if (Type.isNull()) {
8614 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
8615 return QualType();
8616 }
8617 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00008618 case 'p':
8619 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
8620 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00008621 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008622
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008623 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
8624 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008625 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00008626 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008627 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
8628 case '*':
8629 case '&': {
8630 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
8631 // qualified with an address space.
8632 char *End;
8633 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8634 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
8635 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
8636 Str = End;
8637 }
8638 if (c == '*')
8639 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
8640 else
8641 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
8642 break;
8643 }
8644 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
8645 case 'C':
8646 Type = Type.withConst();
8647 break;
8648 case 'D':
8649 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
8650 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00008651 case 'R':
8652 Type = Type.withRestrict();
8653 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008654 }
8655 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008656
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008657 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008658 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008659
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008660 return Type;
8661}
8662
8663/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008664QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008665 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008666 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Eric Christopher02d5d862015-08-06 01:01:12 +00008667 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008668
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008669 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008670
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008671 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008672 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008673 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
8674 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008675 if (Error != GE_None)
8676 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008677
8678 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
8679
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008680 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008681 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008682 if (Error != GE_None)
8683 return QualType();
8684
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008685 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
8686 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
8687 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
8688 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
8689
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008690 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
8691 if (Ty->isArrayType())
8692 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008693
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008694 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
8695 }
8696
David Majnemerba3e5ec2015-03-13 18:26:17 +00008697 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
8698 return QualType();
8699
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008700 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
8701 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
8702
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008703 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00008704 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
8705
8706 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
8707
8708 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
8709 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
8710 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00008711
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008712 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00008713 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
8714 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
Richard Smith391fb862016-10-18 07:13:55 +00008715 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(Id))
8716 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
8717 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_DynamicNone;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008718
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00008719 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008720}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00008721
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008722static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
8723 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008724 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008725 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008726
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008727 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8728 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
8729 case TSK_Undeclared:
8730 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
8731 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8732 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008733
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008734 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008735 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008736
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00008737 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
8738 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
8739 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
8740 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
8741 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
8742 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008743 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008744 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8745
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008746 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008747 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008748 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008749 }
8750
8751 if (!FD->isInlined())
8752 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00008753
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00008754 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
8755 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008756 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00008757 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008758 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
8759
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008760 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
8761 // externally visible.
8762 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
8763 return External;
8764
8765 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008766 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008767 }
8768
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008769 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
8770 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
8771 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
David Majnemer73768702015-03-20 00:02:27 +00008772 if (FD->isMSExternInline())
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008773 return GVA_StrongODR;
8774
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008775 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008776}
8777
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008778static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(const ASTContext &Context,
8779 GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008780 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
8781 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
8782 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
8783 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
8784 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008785 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008786 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
8787 return GVA_StrongODR;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008788 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice &&
8789 D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) {
8790 // Device-side functions with __global__ attribute must always be
8791 // visible externally so they can be launched from host.
8792 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_Internal)
8793 return GVA_StrongODR;
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008794 }
8795 return L;
8796}
8797
8798GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008799 return adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(
8800 *this, basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD), FD);
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008801}
8802
8803static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
8804 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008805 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
8806 return GVA_Internal;
8807
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008808 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
8809 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
8810 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
8811 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
8812 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
8813
Richard Smith9e2341d2015-03-23 03:25:59 +00008814 // Let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the nearest
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008815 // enclosing function.
8816 if (LexicalContext)
8817 StaticLocalLinkage =
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008818 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008819
8820 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
8821 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
8822 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
8823 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
8824 : StaticLocalLinkage;
8825 }
8826
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008827 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
8828 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
8829 // cause link errors.
8830 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
8831 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8832
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00008833 // Most non-template variables have strong linkage; inline variables are
8834 // linkonce_odr or (occasionally, for compatibility) weak_odr.
8835 GVALinkage StrongLinkage;
8836 switch (Context.getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(VD)) {
8837 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None:
8838 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongExternal;
8839 break;
8840 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak:
8841 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008842 StrongLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00008843 break;
8844 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong:
8845 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongODR;
8846 break;
8847 }
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008848
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00008849 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008850 case TSK_Undeclared:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008851 return StrongLinkage;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008852
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008853 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00008854 return Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
8855 VD->isStaticDataMember()
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008856 ? GVA_StrongODR
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008857 : StrongLinkage;
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008858
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008859 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008860 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008861
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008862 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
8863 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8864
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008865 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008866 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008867 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00008868
8869 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008870}
8871
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008872GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008873 return adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(
8874 *this, basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD), VD);
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008875}
8876
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00008877bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008878 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
8879 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
8880 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00008881 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
8882 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
8883 return false;
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00008884 if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
8885 isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
8886 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00008887 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8888 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
8889 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
8890 return false;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00008891 } else if (isa<PragmaCommentDecl>(D))
8892 return true;
Dmitry Polukhin0b0da292016-04-06 11:38:59 +00008893 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D) ||
8894 D->hasAttr<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr>())
8895 return true;
Nico Webercbbaeb12016-03-02 19:28:54 +00008896 else if (isa<PragmaDetectMismatchDecl>(D))
8897 return true;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00008898 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
Alexey Bataevc5b1d322016-03-04 09:22:22 +00008899 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
8900 else if (isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(D))
8901 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
Richard Smithdc1f0422016-07-20 19:10:16 +00008902 else if (isa<ImportDecl>(D))
8903 return true;
Alexey Bataev97720002014-11-11 04:05:39 +00008904 else
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00008905 return false;
8906
8907 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
8908 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008909 return false;
8910
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008911 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
8912 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
8913 return false;
8914
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008915 // Aliases and used decls are required.
8916 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
8917 return true;
8918
8919 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8920 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00008921 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00008922 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008923
8924 // Constructors and destructors are required.
8925 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
8926 return true;
8927
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00008928 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
8929 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
8930 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
8931 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
8932 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
8933 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
8934 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
8935 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
8936 return true;
8937 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008938 }
8939 }
8940
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008941 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
8942 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
8943 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
Justin Lebar606f01f2016-10-13 20:52:17 +00008944 return !isDiscardableGVALinkage(GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008945 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00008946
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008947 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
8948 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
8949
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008950 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
8951 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008952 return false;
8953
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008954 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Justin Lebar606f01f2016-10-13 20:52:17 +00008955 if (!isDiscardableGVALinkage(GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD)))
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008956 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008957
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008958 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
8959 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
8960 return true;
8961
8962 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00008963 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) &&
8964 !VD->evaluateValue())
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008965 return true;
8966
Richard Smithda383632016-08-15 01:33:41 +00008967 // Likewise, variables with tuple-like bindings are required if their
8968 // bindings have side-effects.
8969 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(VD))
8970 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings())
8971 if (auto *BindingVD = BD->getHoldingVar())
8972 if (DeclMustBeEmitted(BindingVD))
8973 return true;
8974
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008975 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008976}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008977
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008978CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
8979 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008980 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008981 if (IsCXXMethod)
8982 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00008983
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00008984 switch (LangOpts.getDefaultCallingConv()) {
8985 case LangOptions::DCC_None:
8986 break;
8987 case LangOptions::DCC_CDecl:
8988 return CC_C;
8989 case LangOptions::DCC_FastCall:
8990 if (getTargetInfo().hasFeature("sse2"))
8991 return CC_X86FastCall;
8992 break;
8993 case LangOptions::DCC_StdCall:
8994 if (!IsVariadic)
8995 return CC_X86StdCall;
8996 break;
8997 case LangOptions::DCC_VectorCall:
8998 // __vectorcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
8999 if (!IsVariadic)
9000 return CC_X86VectorCall;
9001 break;
9002 }
Alexander Kornienko21de0ae2015-01-20 11:20:41 +00009003 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00009004}
9005
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00009006bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00009007 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
9008 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
9009}
9010
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00009011VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
9012 if (!VTContext.get()) {
9013 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
9014 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
9015 else
9016 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
9017 }
9018 return VTContext.get();
9019}
9020
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009021MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009022 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00009023 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009024 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
9025 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +00009026 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009027 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00009028 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +00009029 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +00009030 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00009031 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009032 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00009033 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009034 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009035 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009036}
9037
Angel Garcia Gomez637d1e62015-10-20 13:23:58 +00009038CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00009039
9040size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00009041 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
9042 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
9043 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
9044 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
9045 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
9046 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
9047 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
9048 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
9049 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
9050 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
9051 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
9052 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
9053 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
9054 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00009055}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00009056
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00009057/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
9058/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
9059/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
9060/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
9061QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
9062 unsigned Signed) const {
9063 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
9064 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
9065 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
9066 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
9067 return QualTy;
9068}
9069
9070/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
9071/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
9072/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
9073QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
9074 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
9075 switch (Ty) {
9076 case TargetInfo::Float:
9077 return FloatTy;
9078 case TargetInfo::Double:
9079 return DoubleTy;
9080 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
9081 return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00009082 case TargetInfo::Float128:
9083 return Float128Ty;
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00009084 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
9085 return QualType();
9086 }
9087
9088 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
9089}
9090
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009091void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
9092 if (Number > 1)
9093 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00009094}
9095
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009096unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00009097 auto I = MangleNumbers.find(ND);
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009098 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00009099}
9100
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00009101void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
9102 if (Number > 1)
9103 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
9104}
9105
9106unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00009107 auto I = StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00009108 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
9109}
9110
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009111MangleNumberingContext &
9112ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009113 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
Justin Lebar20ebffc2016-10-10 16:26:19 +00009114 std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext> &MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009115 if (!MCtx)
9116 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
9117 return *MCtx;
9118}
9119
Justin Lebar20ebffc2016-10-10 16:26:19 +00009120std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext>
9121ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009122 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00009123}
9124
David Majnemere7a818f2015-03-06 18:53:55 +00009125const CXXConstructorDecl *
9126ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
9127 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
9128 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
9129}
9130
9131void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
9132 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
9133 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
9134 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
9135 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
9136}
9137
David Majnemerdfa6d202015-03-11 18:36:39 +00009138void ASTContext::addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
9139 unsigned ParmIdx, Expr *DAE) {
9140 ABI->addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
9141 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx, DAE);
9142}
9143
9144Expr *ASTContext::getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
9145 unsigned ParmIdx) {
9146 return ABI->getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
9147 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx);
9148}
9149
David Majnemer00350522015-08-31 18:48:39 +00009150void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
9151 TypedefNameDecl *DD) {
9152 return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
9153}
9154
9155TypedefNameDecl *
9156ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
9157 return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
9158}
9159
9160void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
9161 DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
9162 return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
9163}
9164
9165DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
9166 return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
9167}
9168
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00009169void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
9170 ParamIndices[D] = index;
9171}
9172
9173unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
9174 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
9175 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
9176 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
9177 return I->second;
9178}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009179
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009180APValue *
9181ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
9182 bool MayCreate) {
9183 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
9184 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00009185 if (MayCreate) {
9186 APValue *&MTVI = MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
9187 if (!MTVI)
9188 MTVI = new (*this) APValue;
9189 return MTVI;
9190 }
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009191
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00009192 return MaterializedTemporaryValues.lookup(E);
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009193}
9194
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009195bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
9196 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
9197 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
9198 return false;
9199
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00009200 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
9201 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
9202 return false;
9203
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009204 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
9205 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
9206 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
9207 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
9208 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
9209 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
9210 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
9211}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009212
9213namespace {
9214
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009215ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(
9216 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers::mapped_type U) {
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009217 if (const auto *D = U.dyn_cast<const Decl *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009218 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*D);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009219 if (const auto *S = U.dyn_cast<const Stmt *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009220 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*S);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009221 return *U.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009222}
9223
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009224/// Template specializations to abstract away from pointers and TypeLocs.
9225/// @{
9226template <typename T>
9227ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const T &Node) {
9228 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node);
9229}
9230template <>
9231ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const TypeLoc &Node) {
9232 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
9233}
9234template <>
9235ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode
9236createDynTypedNode(const NestedNameSpecifierLoc &Node) {
9237 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
9238}
9239/// @}
9240
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009241 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
9242 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
9243 ///
9244 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
9245 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
9246 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
9247 ///
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00009248 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009249 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009250 public:
9251 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
9252 ///
9253 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009254 static std::pair<ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *,
9255 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *>
9256 buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
9257 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMapPointers,
9258 new ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009259 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009260 return std::make_pair(Visitor.Parents, Visitor.OtherParents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009261 }
9262
9263 private:
9264 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
9265
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009266 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents,
9267 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents)
9268 : Parents(Parents), OtherParents(OtherParents) {}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009269
9270 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
9271 return true;
9272 }
9273 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
9274 return true;
9275 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009276
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009277 template <typename T, typename MapNodeTy, typename BaseTraverseFn,
9278 typename MapTy>
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009279 bool TraverseNode(T Node, MapNodeTy MapNode,
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009280 BaseTraverseFn BaseTraverse, MapTy *Parents) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00009281 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009282 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009283 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00009284 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
9285 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
9286 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
9287 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
9288 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
9289 // new matches.
9290 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
9291 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
9292 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
9293 // do not have pointer identity.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009294 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[MapNode];
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009295 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009296 if (const auto *D = ParentStack.back().get<Decl>())
9297 NodeOrVector = D;
9298 else if (const auto *S = ParentStack.back().get<Stmt>())
9299 NodeOrVector = S;
9300 else
9301 NodeOrVector =
9302 new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009303 } else {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009304 if (!NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
9305 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(
9306 1, getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(NodeOrVector));
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009307 if (auto *Node =
9308 NodeOrVector
9309 .template dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>())
9310 delete Node;
Benjamin Kramer422b3ff2015-10-23 13:24:18 +00009311 NodeOrVector = Vector;
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00009312 }
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00009313
9314 auto *Vector =
9315 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
9316 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
9317 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
9318 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
9319 // types.
9320 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
9321 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
9322 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
9323 if (!Found)
9324 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009325 }
9326 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009327 ParentStack.push_back(createDynTypedNode(Node));
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009328 bool Result = BaseTraverse();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009329 ParentStack.pop_back();
9330 return Result;
9331 }
9332
9333 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009334 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, DeclNode,
9335 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseDecl(DeclNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009336 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009337 }
9338
9339 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009340 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, StmtNode,
9341 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseStmt(StmtNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009342 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009343 }
9344
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009345 bool TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLoc TypeLocNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009346 return TraverseNode(
9347 TypeLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(TypeLocNode),
9348 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLocNode); },
9349 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009350 }
9351
9352 bool TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLocNode) {
9353 return TraverseNode(
9354 NNSLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(NNSLocNode),
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009355 [&] {
9356 return VisitorBase::TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NNSLocNode);
9357 },
9358 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009359 }
9360
9361 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents;
9362 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009363 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
9364
9365 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
9366 };
9367
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00009368} // anonymous namespace
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009369
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009370template <typename NodeTy, typename MapTy>
9371static ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList getDynNodeFromMap(const NodeTy &Node,
9372 const MapTy &Map) {
9373 auto I = Map.find(Node);
9374 if (I == Map.end()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009375 return llvm::ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009376 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009377 if (auto *V = I->second.template dyn_cast<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009378 return llvm::makeArrayRef(*V);
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009379 }
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009380 return getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(I->second);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009381}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009382
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009383ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList
9384ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
9385 if (!PointerParents) {
9386 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
9387 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
9388 auto Maps = ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl());
9389 PointerParents.reset(Maps.first);
9390 OtherParents.reset(Maps.second);
9391 }
9392 if (Node.getNodeKind().hasPointerIdentity())
9393 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node.getMemoizationData(), *PointerParents);
9394 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node, *OtherParents);
9395}
9396
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009397bool
9398ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
9399 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
9400 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
9401 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
9402 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
9403 return false;
9404 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
9405 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9406 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00009407 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009408 return false;
9409
9410 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
9411 return false;
9412
9413 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
9414 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
9415 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
9416 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
9417 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
9418 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
9419 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9420 return false;
9421 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
9422 return false;
9423 }
9424 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
9425
9426}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00009427
9428// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
9429// doesn't include ASTContext.h
9430template
9431clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9432 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
9433clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9434 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
9435 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);